| /* GTK - The GIMP Toolkit |
| * Copyright (C) 1995-1997 Peter Mattis, Spencer Kimball and Josh MacDonald |
| * |
| * This library is free software; you can redistribute it and/or |
| * modify it under the terms of the GNU Lesser General Public |
| * License as published by the Free Software Foundation; either |
| * version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later version. |
| * |
| * This library is distributed in the hope that it will be useful, |
| * but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of |
| * MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU |
| * Lesser General Public License for more details. |
| * |
| * You should have received a copy of the GNU Lesser General Public |
| * License along with this library. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. |
| */ |
| |
| /* |
| * Modified by the GTK+ Team and others 1997-2000. See the AUTHORS |
| * file for a list of people on the GTK+ Team. See the ChangeLog |
| * files for a list of changes. These files are distributed with |
| * GTK+ at ftp://ftp.gtk.org/pub/gtk/. |
| */ |
| |
| #include "config.h" |
| |
| #include "gtkwidgetprivate.h" |
| |
| #include "gtkaccelmapprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkaccelgroupprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkaccessible.h" |
| #include "gtkapplicationprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkbindings.h" |
| #include "gtkbuildable.h" |
| #include "gtkbuilderprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcontainerprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcssboxesprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcssfiltervalueprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcsstransformvalueprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcssfontvariationsvalueprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcssnumbervalueprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcssshadowsvalueprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcssstylepropertyprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkcsswidgetnodeprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkdebug.h" |
| #include "gtkgesturedrag.h" |
| #include "gtkgestureprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkgesturesingle.h" |
| #include "gtkgestureswipe.h" |
| #include "gtkintl.h" |
| #include "gtklayoutmanagerprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkmain.h" |
| #include "gtkmarshalers.h" |
| #include "gtkmenu.h" |
| #include "gtkpopover.h" |
| #include "gtkprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkrenderbackgroundprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkrenderborderprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkscrollable.h" |
| #include "gtkselection.h" |
| #include "gtksettingsprivate.h" |
| #include "gtksizegroup-private.h" |
| #include "gtksnapshotprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkstylecontextprivate.h" |
| #include "gtktooltipprivate.h" |
| #include "gsktransformprivate.h" |
| #include "gtktypebuiltins.h" |
| #include "gtkversion.h" |
| #include "gtkwidgetpaintableprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkwidgetpathprivate.h" |
| #include "gtkwindowgroup.h" |
| #include "gtkwindowprivate.h" |
| |
| #include "a11y/gtkwidgetaccessible.h" |
| #include "inspector/window.h" |
| |
| #include "gdk/gdkeventsprivate.h" |
| #include "gsk/gskdebugprivate.h" |
| #include "gsk/gskrendererprivate.h" |
| |
| #include <cairo-gobject.h> |
| #include <gobject/gobjectnotifyqueue.c> |
| #include <gobject/gvaluecollector.h> |
| #include <locale.h> |
| #include <math.h> |
| #include <stdarg.h> |
| #include <string.h> |
| |
| /* for the use of round() */ |
| #include "fallback-c89.c" |
| |
| /** |
| * SECTION:gtkwidget |
| * @Short_description: Base class for all widgets |
| * @Title: GtkWidget |
| * |
| * GtkWidget is the base class all widgets in GTK+ derive from. It manages the |
| * widget lifecycle, states and style. |
| * |
| * # Height-for-width Geometry Management # {#geometry-management} |
| * |
| * GTK+ uses a height-for-width (and width-for-height) geometry management |
| * system. Height-for-width means that a widget can change how much |
| * vertical space it needs, depending on the amount of horizontal space |
| * that it is given (and similar for width-for-height). The most common |
| * example is a label that reflows to fill up the available width, wraps |
| * to fewer lines, and therefore needs less height. |
| * |
| * Height-for-width geometry management is implemented in GTK+ by way |
| * of two virtual methods: |
| * |
| * - #GtkWidgetClass.get_request_mode() |
| * - #GtkWidgetClass.measure() |
| * |
| * There are some important things to keep in mind when implementing |
| * height-for-width and when using it in widget implementations. |
| * |
| * If you implement a direct #GtkWidget subclass that supports |
| * height-for-width or width-for-height geometry management for |
| * itself or its child widgets, the #GtkWidgetClass.get_request_mode() |
| * virtual function must be implemented as well and return the widget's |
| * preferred request mode. The default implementation of this virtual function |
| * returns %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_CONSTANT_SIZE, which means that the widget will only ever |
| * get -1 passed as the for_size value to its #GtkWidgetClass.measure() implementation. |
| * |
| * The geometry management system will query a widget hierarchy in |
| * only one orientation at a time. When widgets are initially queried |
| * for their minimum sizes it is generally done in two initial passes |
| * in the #GtkSizeRequestMode chosen by the toplevel. |
| * |
| * For example, when queried in the normal |
| * %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH mode: |
| * First, the default minimum and natural width for each widget |
| * in the interface will be computed using gtk_widget_measure() with an orientation |
| * of %GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL and a for_size of -1. |
| * Because the preferred widths for each widget depend on the preferred |
| * widths of their children, this information propagates up the hierarchy, |
| * and finally a minimum and natural width is determined for the entire |
| * toplevel. Next, the toplevel will use the minimum width to query for the |
| * minimum height contextual to that width using gtk_widget_measure() with an |
| * orientation of %GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL and a for_size of the just computed |
| * width. This will also be a highly recursive operation. |
| * The minimum height for the minimum width is normally |
| * used to set the minimum size constraint on the toplevel |
| * (unless gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() is explicitly used instead). |
| * |
| * After the toplevel window has initially requested its size in both |
| * dimensions it can go on to allocate itself a reasonable size (or a size |
| * previously specified with gtk_window_set_default_size()). During the |
| * recursive allocation process it’s important to note that request cycles |
| * will be recursively executed while widgets allocate their children. |
| * Each widget, once allocated a size, will go on to first share the |
| * space in one orientation among its children and then request each child's |
| * height for its target allocated width or its width for allocated height, |
| * depending. In this way a #GtkWidget will typically be requested its size |
| * a number of times before actually being allocated a size. The size a |
| * widget is finally allocated can of course differ from the size it has |
| * requested. For this reason, #GtkWidget caches a small number of results |
| * to avoid re-querying for the same sizes in one allocation cycle. |
| * |
| * If a widget does move content around to intelligently use up the |
| * allocated size then it must support the request in both |
| * #GtkSizeRequestModes even if the widget in question only |
| * trades sizes in a single orientation. |
| * |
| * For instance, a #GtkLabel that does height-for-width word wrapping |
| * will not expect to have #GtkWidgetClass.measure() with an orientation of |
| * %GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL called because that call is specific to a |
| * width-for-height request. In this |
| * case the label must return the height required for its own minimum |
| * possible width. By following this rule any widget that handles |
| * height-for-width or width-for-height requests will always be allocated |
| * at least enough space to fit its own content. |
| * |
| * Here are some examples of how a %GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH widget |
| * generally deals with width-for-height requests: |
| * |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * static void |
| * foo_widget_measure (GtkWidget *widget, |
| * GtkOrientation orientation, |
| * int for_size, |
| * int *minimum_size, |
| * int *natural_size, |
| * int *minimum_baseline, |
| * int *natural_baseline) |
| * { |
| * if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) |
| * { |
| * // Calculate minimum and natural width |
| * } |
| * else // VERTICAL |
| * { |
| * if (i_am_in_height_for_width_mode) |
| * { |
| * int min_width, dummy; |
| * |
| * // First, get the minimum width of our widget |
| * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, -1, |
| * &min_width, &dummy, &dummy, &dummy); |
| * |
| * // Now use the minimum width to retrieve the minimum and natural height to display |
| * // that width. |
| * GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, min_width, |
| * minimum_size, natural_size, &dummy, &dummy); |
| * } |
| * else |
| * { |
| * // ... some widgets do both. |
| * } |
| * } |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * Often a widget needs to get its own request during size request or |
| * allocation. For example, when computing height it may need to also |
| * compute width. Or when deciding how to use an allocation, the widget |
| * may need to know its natural size. In these cases, the widget should |
| * be careful to call its virtual methods directly, like in the code |
| * example above. |
| * |
| * It will not work to use the wrapper function gtk_widget_measure() |
| * inside your own #GtkWidgetClass.size-allocate() implementation. |
| * These return a request adjusted by #GtkSizeGroup, the widget's align and expand flags |
| * as well as its CSS style. |
| * If a widget used the wrappers inside its virtual method implementations, |
| * then the adjustments (such as widget margins) would be applied |
| * twice. GTK+ therefore does not allow this and will warn if you try |
| * to do it. |
| * |
| * Of course if you are getting the size request for |
| * another widget, such as a child widget, you must use gtk_widget_measure(). |
| * Otherwise, you would not properly consider widget margins, |
| * #GtkSizeGroup, and so forth. |
| * |
| * GTK+ also supports baseline vertical alignment of widgets. This |
| * means that widgets are positioned such that the typographical baseline of |
| * widgets in the same row are aligned. This happens if a widget supports baselines, |
| * has a vertical alignment of %GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE, and is inside a widget |
| * that supports baselines and has a natural “row” that it aligns to the baseline, |
| * or a baseline assigned to it by the grandparent. |
| * |
| * Baseline alignment support for a widget is also done by the #GtkWidgetClass.measure() |
| * virtual function. It allows you to report a both a minimum and natural |
| * |
| * If a widget ends up baseline aligned it will be allocated all the space in the parent |
| * as if it was %GTK_ALIGN_FILL, but the selected baseline can be found via gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline(). |
| * If this has a value other than -1 you need to align the widget such that the baseline |
| * appears at the position. |
| * |
| * # GtkWidget as GtkBuildable |
| * |
| * The GtkWidget implementation of the GtkBuildable interface supports a |
| * custom <accelerator> element, which has attributes named ”key”, ”modifiers” |
| * and ”signal” and allows to specify accelerators. |
| * |
| * An example of a UI definition fragment specifying an accelerator: |
| * |[ |
| * <object class="GtkButton"> |
| * <accelerator key="q" modifiers="GDK_CONTROL_MASK" signal="clicked"/> |
| * </object> |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * In addition to accelerators, GtkWidget also support a custom <accessible> |
| * element, which supports actions and relations. Properties on the accessible |
| * implementation of an object can be set by accessing the internal child |
| * “accessible” of a #GtkWidget. |
| * |
| * An example of a UI definition fragment specifying an accessible: |
| * |[ |
| * <object class="GtkLabel" id="label1"/> |
| * <property name="label">I am a Label for a Button</property> |
| * </object> |
| * <object class="GtkButton" id="button1"> |
| * <accessibility> |
| * <action action_name="click" translatable="yes">Click the button.</action> |
| * <relation target="label1" type="labelled-by"/> |
| * </accessibility> |
| * <child internal-child="accessible"> |
| * <object class="AtkObject" id="a11y-button1"> |
| * <property name="accessible-name">Clickable Button</property> |
| * </object> |
| * </child> |
| * </object> |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * If the parent widget uses a #GtkLayoutManager, #GtkWidget supports a |
| * custom <layout> element, used to define layout properties: |
| * |
| * |[ |
| * <object class="MyGrid" id="grid1"> |
| * <child> |
| * <object class="GtkLabel" id="label1"> |
| * <property name="label">Description</property> |
| * <layout> |
| * <property name="left-attach">0</property> |
| * <property name="top-attach">0</property> |
| * <property name="row-span">1</property> |
| * <property name="col-span">1</property> |
| * </layout> |
| * </object> |
| * </child> |
| * <child> |
| * <object class="GtkEntry" id="description_entry"> |
| * <layout> |
| * <property name="left-attach">1</property> |
| * <property name="top-attach">0</property> |
| * <property name="row-span">1</property> |
| * <property name="col-span">1</property> |
| * </layout> |
| * </object> |
| * </child> |
| * </object> |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * Finally, GtkWidget allows style information such as style classes to |
| * be associated with widgets, using the custom <style> element: |
| * |[ |
| * <object class="GtkButton" id="button1"> |
| * <style> |
| * <class name="my-special-button-class"/> |
| * <class name="dark-button"/> |
| * </style> |
| * </object> |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * # Building composite widgets from template XML ## {#composite-templates} |
| * |
| * GtkWidget exposes some facilities to automate the procedure |
| * of creating composite widgets using #GtkBuilder interface description |
| * language. |
| * |
| * To create composite widgets with #GtkBuilder XML, one must associate |
| * the interface description with the widget class at class initialization |
| * time using gtk_widget_class_set_template(). |
| * |
| * The interface description semantics expected in composite template descriptions |
| * is slightly different from regular #GtkBuilder XML. |
| * |
| * Unlike regular interface descriptions, gtk_widget_class_set_template() will |
| * expect a <template> tag as a direct child of the toplevel <interface> |
| * tag. The <template> tag must specify the “class” attribute which must be |
| * the type name of the widget. Optionally, the “parent” attribute may be |
| * specified to specify the direct parent type of the widget type, this is |
| * ignored by the GtkBuilder but required for Glade to introspect what kind |
| * of properties and internal children exist for a given type when the actual |
| * type does not exist. |
| * |
| * The XML which is contained inside the <template> tag behaves as if it were |
| * added to the <object> tag defining @widget itself. You may set properties |
| * on @widget by inserting <property> tags into the <template> tag, and also |
| * add <child> tags to add children and extend @widget in the normal way you |
| * would with <object> tags. |
| * |
| * Additionally, <object> tags can also be added before and after the initial |
| * <template> tag in the normal way, allowing one to define auxiliary objects |
| * which might be referenced by other widgets declared as children of the |
| * <template> tag. |
| * |
| * An example of a GtkBuilder Template Definition: |
| * |[ |
| * <interface> |
| * <template class="FooWidget" parent="GtkBox"> |
| * <property name="orientation">GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL</property> |
| * <property name="spacing">4</property> |
| * <child> |
| * <object class="GtkButton" id="hello_button"> |
| * <property name="label">Hello World</property> |
| * <signal name="clicked" handler="hello_button_clicked" object="FooWidget" swapped="yes"/> |
| * </object> |
| * </child> |
| * <child> |
| * <object class="GtkButton" id="goodbye_button"> |
| * <property name="label">Goodbye World</property> |
| * </object> |
| * </child> |
| * </template> |
| * </interface> |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * Typically, you'll place the template fragment into a file that is |
| * bundled with your project, using #GResource. In order to load the |
| * template, you need to call gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource() |
| * from the class initialization of your #GtkWidget type: |
| * |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * static void |
| * foo_widget_class_init (FooWidgetClass *klass) |
| * { |
| * // ... |
| * |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), |
| * "/com/example/ui/foowidget.ui"); |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * You will also need to call gtk_widget_init_template() from the instance |
| * initialization function: |
| * |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * static void |
| * foo_widget_init (FooWidget *self) |
| * { |
| * // ... |
| * gtk_widget_init_template (GTK_WIDGET (self)); |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * You can access widgets defined in the template using the |
| * gtk_widget_get_template_child() function, but you will typically declare |
| * a pointer in the instance private data structure of your type using the same |
| * name as the widget in the template definition, and call |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private() with that name, e.g. |
| * |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * typedef struct { |
| * GtkWidget *hello_button; |
| * GtkWidget *goodbye_button; |
| * } FooWidgetPrivate; |
| * |
| * G_DEFINE_TYPE_WITH_PRIVATE (FooWidget, foo_widget, GTK_TYPE_BOX) |
| * |
| * static void |
| * foo_widget_class_init (FooWidgetClass *klass) |
| * { |
| * // ... |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), |
| * "/com/example/ui/foowidget.ui"); |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), |
| * FooWidget, hello_button); |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), |
| * FooWidget, goodbye_button); |
| * } |
| * |
| * static void |
| * foo_widget_init (FooWidget *widget) |
| * { |
| * |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * You can also use gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback() to connect a signal |
| * callback defined in the template with a function visible in the scope of the |
| * class, e.g. |
| * |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * // the signal handler has the instance and user data swapped |
| * // because of the swapped="yes" attribute in the template XML |
| * static void |
| * hello_button_clicked (FooWidget *self, |
| * GtkButton *button) |
| * { |
| * g_print ("Hello, world!\n"); |
| * } |
| * |
| * static void |
| * foo_widget_class_init (FooWidgetClass *klass) |
| * { |
| * // ... |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), |
| * "/com/example/ui/foowidget.ui"); |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback (GTK_WIDGET_CLASS (klass), hello_button_clicked); |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| */ |
| |
| #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_SET_PROPAGATE (GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE | \ |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_BACKDROP) |
| #define GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_UNSET_PROPAGATE (GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE | \ |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_BACKDROP | \ |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT | \ |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE) |
| |
| typedef struct { |
| gchar *name; /* Name of the template automatic child */ |
| gboolean internal_child; /* Whether the automatic widget should be exported as an <internal-child> */ |
| gssize offset; /* Instance private data offset where to set the automatic child (or 0) */ |
| } AutomaticChildClass; |
| |
| typedef struct { |
| gchar *callback_name; |
| GCallback callback_symbol; |
| } CallbackSymbol; |
| |
| typedef struct { |
| GBytes *data; |
| GSList *children; |
| GSList *callbacks; |
| GtkBuilderConnectFunc connect_func; |
| gpointer connect_data; |
| GDestroyNotify destroy_notify; |
| } GtkWidgetTemplate; |
| |
| struct _GtkWidgetClassPrivate |
| { |
| GtkWidgetTemplate *template; |
| GType accessible_type; |
| AtkRole accessible_role; |
| const char *css_name; |
| GType layout_manager_type; |
| }; |
| |
| enum { |
| DESTROY, |
| SHOW, |
| HIDE, |
| MAP, |
| UNMAP, |
| REALIZE, |
| UNREALIZE, |
| SIZE_ALLOCATE, |
| STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED, |
| HIERARCHY_CHANGED, |
| DIRECTION_CHANGED, |
| GRAB_NOTIFY, |
| CHILD_NOTIFY, |
| MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE, |
| MOVE_FOCUS, |
| KEYNAV_FAILED, |
| DRAG_BEGIN, |
| DRAG_END, |
| DRAG_DATA_DELETE, |
| DRAG_LEAVE, |
| DRAG_MOTION, |
| DRAG_DROP, |
| DRAG_DATA_GET, |
| DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED, |
| POPUP_MENU, |
| ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED, |
| DISPLAY_CHANGED, |
| CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL, |
| QUERY_TOOLTIP, |
| DRAG_FAILED, |
| STYLE_UPDATED, |
| LAST_SIGNAL |
| }; |
| |
| enum { |
| PROP_0, |
| PROP_NAME, |
| PROP_PARENT, |
| PROP_ROOT, |
| PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST, |
| PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST, |
| PROP_VISIBLE, |
| PROP_SENSITIVE, |
| PROP_CAN_FOCUS, |
| PROP_HAS_FOCUS, |
| PROP_IS_FOCUS, |
| PROP_CAN_TARGET, |
| PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK, |
| PROP_HAS_DEFAULT, |
| PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT, |
| PROP_CURSOR, |
| PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP, |
| PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP, |
| PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT, |
| PROP_SURFACE, |
| PROP_OPACITY, |
| PROP_OVERFLOW, |
| PROP_HALIGN, |
| PROP_VALIGN, |
| PROP_MARGIN_START, |
| PROP_MARGIN_END, |
| PROP_MARGIN_TOP, |
| PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM, |
| PROP_MARGIN, |
| PROP_HEXPAND, |
| PROP_VEXPAND, |
| PROP_HEXPAND_SET, |
| PROP_VEXPAND_SET, |
| PROP_EXPAND, |
| PROP_SCALE_FACTOR, |
| PROP_CSS_NAME, |
| PROP_LAYOUT_MANAGER, |
| NUM_PROPERTIES |
| }; |
| |
| static GParamSpec *widget_props[NUM_PROPERTIES] = { NULL, }; |
| |
| typedef struct _GtkStateData GtkStateData; |
| |
| struct _GtkStateData |
| { |
| guint flags_to_set; |
| guint flags_to_unset; |
| |
| gint old_scale_factor; |
| }; |
| |
| /* --- prototypes --- */ |
| static void gtk_widget_base_class_init (gpointer g_class); |
| static void gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass); |
| static void gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass); |
| static void gtk_widget_init (GTypeInstance *instance, |
| gpointer g_class); |
| static void gtk_widget_set_property (GObject *object, |
| guint prop_id, |
| const GValue *value, |
| GParamSpec *pspec); |
| static void gtk_widget_get_property (GObject *object, |
| guint prop_id, |
| GValue *value, |
| GParamSpec *pspec); |
| static void gtk_widget_constructed (GObject *object); |
| static void gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object); |
| static void gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| int width, |
| int height, |
| int baseline); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_direction_changed(GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTextDirection previous_direction); |
| |
| static void gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget); |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint x, |
| gint y, |
| gboolean keyboard_tip, |
| GtkTooltip *tooltip); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget); |
| |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction); |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction); |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS |
| static void gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget); |
| #else |
| #define gtk_widget_verify_invariants(widget) |
| #define gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants(widget) |
| #define gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants(widget) |
| #endif |
| static PangoContext* gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GtkStateData *data); |
| static void gtk_widget_update_alpha (GtkWidget *widget); |
| |
| static gint gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GdkEvent *event); |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean group_cycling); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_measure (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation, |
| int for_size, |
| int *minimum, |
| int *natural, |
| int *minimum_baseline, |
| int *natural_baseline); |
| static void gtk_widget_real_state_flags_changed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkStateFlags old_state); |
| static AtkObject* gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface); |
| static AtkObject* gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor); |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, |
| guint signal_id); |
| |
| static void gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface); |
| static void gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| const gchar *name); |
| static const gchar * gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable); |
| static GObject * gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| const gchar *childname); |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *tagname, |
| GMarkupParser *parser, |
| gpointer *data); |
| static void gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_end (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *tagname, |
| gpointer data); |
| static void gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *tagname, |
| gpointer data); |
| static void gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder); |
| |
| static GtkSizeRequestMode gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget); |
| |
| static void template_data_free (GtkWidgetTemplate*template_data); |
| |
| static void gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint width, |
| gint height); |
| |
| static gboolean event_surface_is_still_viewable (const GdkEvent *event); |
| |
| static void gtk_widget_update_input_shape (GtkWidget *widget); |
| |
| static gboolean gtk_widget_class_get_visible_by_default (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class); |
| |
| static void remove_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (GtkWidget *widget); |
| static void add_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (GtkWidget *widget); |
| |
| |
| /* --- variables --- */ |
| static gint GtkWidget_private_offset = 0; |
| static gpointer gtk_widget_parent_class = NULL; |
| static guint widget_signals[LAST_SIGNAL] = { 0 }; |
| GtkTextDirection gtk_default_direction = GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR; |
| |
| static GQuark quark_accel_path = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_accel_closures = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_input_shape_info = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_pango_context = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_mnemonic_labels = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_tooltip_markup = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_tooltip_window = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_size_groups = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_auto_children = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_widget_path = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_action_muxer = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_font_options = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_font_map = 0; |
| |
| /* --- functions --- */ |
| GType |
| gtk_widget_get_type (void) |
| { |
| static GType widget_type = 0; |
| |
| if (G_UNLIKELY (widget_type == 0)) |
| { |
| const GTypeInfo widget_info = |
| { |
| sizeof (GtkWidgetClass), |
| gtk_widget_base_class_init, |
| (GBaseFinalizeFunc) gtk_widget_base_class_finalize, |
| (GClassInitFunc) gtk_widget_class_init, |
| NULL, /* class_finalize */ |
| NULL, /* class_init */ |
| sizeof (GtkWidget), |
| 0, /* n_preallocs */ |
| gtk_widget_init, |
| NULL, /* value_table */ |
| }; |
| |
| const GInterfaceInfo accessibility_info = |
| { |
| (GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init, |
| (GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL, |
| NULL /* interface data */ |
| }; |
| |
| const GInterfaceInfo buildable_info = |
| { |
| (GInterfaceInitFunc) gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init, |
| (GInterfaceFinalizeFunc) NULL, |
| NULL /* interface data */ |
| }; |
| |
| widget_type = g_type_register_static (G_TYPE_INITIALLY_UNOWNED, g_intern_static_string ("GtkWidget"), |
| &widget_info, G_TYPE_FLAG_ABSTRACT); |
| |
| g_type_add_class_private (widget_type, sizeof (GtkWidgetClassPrivate)); |
| |
| GtkWidget_private_offset = |
| g_type_add_instance_private (widget_type, sizeof (GtkWidgetPrivate)); |
| |
| g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, ATK_TYPE_IMPLEMENTOR, |
| &accessibility_info) ; |
| g_type_add_interface_static (widget_type, GTK_TYPE_BUILDABLE, |
| &buildable_info) ; |
| } |
| |
| return widget_type; |
| } |
| |
| static inline gpointer |
| gtk_widget_get_instance_private (GtkWidget *self) |
| { |
| return (G_STRUCT_MEMBER_P (self, GtkWidget_private_offset)); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_base_class_init (gpointer g_class) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClass *klass = g_class; |
| |
| klass->priv = G_TYPE_CLASS_GET_PRIVATE (g_class, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, GtkWidgetClassPrivate); |
| klass->priv->template = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_snapshot (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkSnapshot *snapshot) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| gtk_widget_snapshot_child (widget, child, snapshot); |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_real_contains (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gdouble x, |
| gdouble y) |
| { |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| |
| return gsk_rounded_rect_contains_point (gtk_css_boxes_get_border_box (&boxes), |
| &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (x, y)); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_grab_notify (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean was_grabbed) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| for (l = g_list_last (priv->event_controllers); l; l = l->prev) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| GdkDevice *device = NULL; |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| device = gtk_gesture_get_device (GTK_GESTURE (controller)); |
| |
| if (!device || !gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed (widget, device)) |
| continue; |
| |
| gtk_event_controller_reset (controller); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_root (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_root, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_unroot (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, (GtkCallback) gtk_widget_unroot, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_class_init (GtkWidgetClass *klass) |
| { |
| GObjectClass *gobject_class = G_OBJECT_CLASS (klass); |
| GtkBindingSet *binding_set; |
| |
| g_type_class_adjust_private_offset (klass, &GtkWidget_private_offset); |
| gtk_widget_parent_class = g_type_class_peek_parent (klass); |
| |
| quark_accel_path = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-path"); |
| quark_accel_closures = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-accel-closures"); |
| quark_input_shape_info = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-input-shape-info"); |
| quark_pango_context = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-pango-context"); |
| quark_mnemonic_labels = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-mnemonic-labels"); |
| quark_tooltip_markup = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-markup"); |
| quark_tooltip_window = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-tooltip-window"); |
| quark_size_groups = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-size-groups"); |
| quark_auto_children = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-auto-children"); |
| quark_widget_path = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-path"); |
| quark_action_muxer = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-action-muxer"); |
| quark_font_options = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-font-options"); |
| quark_font_map = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-widget-font-map"); |
| |
| gobject_class->constructed = gtk_widget_constructed; |
| gobject_class->dispose = gtk_widget_dispose; |
| gobject_class->finalize = gtk_widget_finalize; |
| gobject_class->set_property = gtk_widget_set_property; |
| gobject_class->get_property = gtk_widget_get_property; |
| |
| klass->destroy = gtk_widget_real_destroy; |
| |
| klass->activate_signal = 0; |
| klass->show = gtk_widget_real_show; |
| klass->hide = gtk_widget_real_hide; |
| klass->map = gtk_widget_real_map; |
| klass->unmap = gtk_widget_real_unmap; |
| klass->realize = gtk_widget_real_realize; |
| klass->unrealize = gtk_widget_real_unrealize; |
| klass->root = gtk_widget_real_root; |
| klass->unroot = gtk_widget_real_unroot; |
| klass->size_allocate = gtk_widget_real_size_allocate; |
| klass->get_request_mode = gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode; |
| klass->measure = gtk_widget_real_measure; |
| klass->state_flags_changed = gtk_widget_real_state_flags_changed; |
| klass->direction_changed = gtk_widget_real_direction_changed; |
| klass->grab_notify = gtk_widget_real_grab_notify; |
| klass->snapshot = gtk_widget_real_snapshot; |
| klass->mnemonic_activate = gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate; |
| klass->grab_focus = gtk_widget_real_grab_focus; |
| klass->focus = gtk_widget_real_focus; |
| klass->move_focus = gtk_widget_real_move_focus; |
| klass->keynav_failed = gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed; |
| klass->drag_begin = NULL; |
| klass->drag_end = NULL; |
| klass->drag_data_delete = NULL; |
| klass->drag_leave = NULL; |
| klass->drag_motion = NULL; |
| klass->drag_drop = NULL; |
| klass->drag_data_received = NULL; |
| klass->can_activate_accel = gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel; |
| klass->query_tooltip = gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip; |
| klass->style_updated = gtk_widget_real_style_updated; |
| |
| /* Accessibility support */ |
| klass->priv->accessible_type = GTK_TYPE_ACCESSIBLE; |
| klass->priv->accessible_role = ATK_ROLE_INVALID; |
| klass->get_accessible = gtk_widget_real_get_accessible; |
| |
| klass->contains = gtk_widget_real_contains; |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_NAME] = |
| g_param_spec_string ("name", |
| P_("Widget name"), |
| P_("The name of the widget"), |
| NULL, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_PARENT] = |
| g_param_spec_object ("parent", |
| P_("Parent widget"), |
| P_("The parent widget of this widget."), |
| GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, |
| GTK_PARAM_READABLE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:root: |
| * |
| * The #GtkRoot widget of the widget tree containing this widget or %NULL if |
| * the widget is not contained in a root widget. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_ROOT] = |
| g_param_spec_object ("root", |
| P_("Root widget"), |
| P_("The root widget in the widget tree."), |
| GTK_TYPE_ROOT, |
| GTK_PARAM_READABLE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("width-request", |
| P_("Width request"), |
| P_("Override for width request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"), |
| -1, G_MAXINT, |
| -1, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("height-request", |
| P_("Height request"), |
| P_("Override for height request of the widget, or -1 if natural request should be used"), |
| -1, G_MAXINT, |
| -1, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_VISIBLE] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("visible", |
| P_("Visible"), |
| P_("Whether the widget is visible"), |
| TRUE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_SENSITIVE] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("sensitive", |
| P_("Sensitive"), |
| P_("Whether the widget responds to input"), |
| TRUE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_CAN_FOCUS] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("can-focus", |
| P_("Can focus"), |
| P_("Whether the widget can accept the input focus"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_HAS_FOCUS] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("has-focus", |
| P_("Has focus"), |
| P_("Whether the widget has the input focus"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_IS_FOCUS] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("is-focus", |
| P_("Is focus"), |
| P_("Whether the widget is the focus widget within the toplevel"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_CAN_TARGET] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("can-target", |
| P_("Can target"), |
| P_("Whether the widget can receive pointer events"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:focus-on-click: |
| * |
| * Whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse. |
| * |
| * This property is only relevant for widgets that can take focus. |
| * |
| * Before 3.20, several widgets (GtkButton, GtkFileChooserButton, |
| * GtkComboBox) implemented this property individually. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("focus-on-click", |
| P_("Focus on click"), |
| P_("Whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse"), |
| TRUE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_HAS_DEFAULT] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("has-default", |
| P_("Has default"), |
| P_("Whether the widget is the default widget"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READABLE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| widget_props[PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("receives-default", |
| P_("Receives default"), |
| P_("If TRUE, the widget will receive the default action when it is focused"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:cursor: |
| * |
| * The cursor used by @widget. See gtk_widget_set_cursor() for details. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_CURSOR] = |
| g_param_spec_object("cursor", |
| P_("Cursor"), |
| P_("The cursor to show when hoving above widget"), |
| GDK_TYPE_CURSOR, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:has-tooltip: |
| * |
| * Enables or disables the emission of #GtkWidget::query-tooltip on @widget. |
| * A value of %TRUE indicates that @widget can have a tooltip, in this case |
| * the widget will be queried using #GtkWidget::query-tooltip to determine |
| * whether it will provide a tooltip or not. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("has-tooltip", |
| P_("Has tooltip"), |
| P_("Whether this widget has a tooltip"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:tooltip-text: |
| * |
| * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string. |
| * |
| * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_text(). |
| * |
| * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the |
| * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip |
| * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of |
| * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler. |
| * |
| * Note that if both #GtkWidget:tooltip-text and #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup |
| * are set, the last one wins. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT] = |
| g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-text", |
| P_("Tooltip Text"), |
| P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"), |
| NULL, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:tooltip-markup: |
| * |
| * Sets the text of tooltip to be the given string, which is marked up |
| * with the [Pango text markup language][PangoMarkupFormat]. |
| * Also see gtk_tooltip_set_markup(). |
| * |
| * This is a convenience property which will take care of getting the |
| * tooltip shown if the given string is not %NULL: #GtkWidget:has-tooltip |
| * will automatically be set to %TRUE and there will be taken care of |
| * #GtkWidget::query-tooltip in the default signal handler. |
| * |
| * Note that if both #GtkWidget:tooltip-text and #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup |
| * are set, the last one wins. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP] = |
| g_param_spec_string ("tooltip-markup", |
| P_("Tooltip markup"), |
| P_("The contents of the tooltip for this widget"), |
| NULL, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:surface: |
| * |
| * The widget's surface if it is realized, %NULL otherwise. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_SURFACE] = |
| g_param_spec_object ("surface", |
| P_("Surface"), |
| P_("The widget’s surface if it is realized"), |
| GDK_TYPE_SURFACE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READABLE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:halign: |
| * |
| * How to distribute horizontal space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_HALIGN] = |
| g_param_spec_enum ("halign", |
| P_("Horizontal Alignment"), |
| P_("How to position in extra horizontal space"), |
| GTK_TYPE_ALIGN, |
| GTK_ALIGN_FILL, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:valign: |
| * |
| * How to distribute vertical space if widget gets extra space, see #GtkAlign |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_VALIGN] = |
| g_param_spec_enum ("valign", |
| P_("Vertical Alignment"), |
| P_("How to position in extra vertical space"), |
| GTK_TYPE_ALIGN, |
| GTK_ALIGN_FILL, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:margin-start: |
| * |
| * Margin on start of widget, horizontally. This property supports |
| * left-to-right and right-to-left text directions. |
| * |
| * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size |
| * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_START] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("margin-start", |
| P_("Margin on Start"), |
| P_("Pixels of extra space on the start"), |
| 0, G_MAXINT16, |
| 0, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:margin-end: |
| * |
| * Margin on end of widget, horizontally. This property supports |
| * left-to-right and right-to-left text directions. |
| * |
| * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size |
| * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_END] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("margin-end", |
| P_("Margin on End"), |
| P_("Pixels of extra space on the end"), |
| 0, G_MAXINT16, |
| 0, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:margin-top: |
| * |
| * Margin on top side of widget. |
| * |
| * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size |
| * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_TOP] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("margin-top", |
| P_("Margin on Top"), |
| P_("Pixels of extra space on the top side"), |
| 0, G_MAXINT16, |
| 0, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:margin-bottom: |
| * |
| * Margin on bottom side of widget. |
| * |
| * This property adds margin outside of the widget's normal size |
| * request, the margin will be added in addition to the size from |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request() for example. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("margin-bottom", |
| P_("Margin on Bottom"), |
| P_("Pixels of extra space on the bottom side"), |
| 0, G_MAXINT16, |
| 0, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:margin: |
| * |
| * Sets all four sides' margin at once. If read, returns max |
| * margin on any side. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_MARGIN] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("margin", |
| P_("All Margins"), |
| P_("Pixels of extra space on all four sides"), |
| 0, G_MAXINT16, |
| 0, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:hexpand: |
| * |
| * Whether to expand horizontally. See gtk_widget_set_hexpand(). |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_HEXPAND] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand", |
| P_("Horizontal Expand"), |
| P_("Whether widget wants more horizontal space"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:hexpand-set: |
| * |
| * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:hexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set(). |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_HEXPAND_SET] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("hexpand-set", |
| P_("Horizontal Expand Set"), |
| P_("Whether to use the hexpand property"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:vexpand: |
| * |
| * Whether to expand vertically. See gtk_widget_set_vexpand(). |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_VEXPAND] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand", |
| P_("Vertical Expand"), |
| P_("Whether widget wants more vertical space"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:vexpand-set: |
| * |
| * Whether to use the #GtkWidget:vexpand property. See gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set(). |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_VEXPAND_SET] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("vexpand-set", |
| P_("Vertical Expand Set"), |
| P_("Whether to use the vexpand property"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:expand: |
| * |
| * Whether to expand in both directions. Setting this sets both #GtkWidget:hexpand and #GtkWidget:vexpand |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_EXPAND] = |
| g_param_spec_boolean ("expand", |
| P_("Expand Both"), |
| P_("Whether widget wants to expand in both directions"), |
| FALSE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:opacity: |
| * |
| * The requested opacity of the widget. See gtk_widget_set_opacity() for |
| * more details about window opacity. |
| * |
| * Before 3.8 this was only available in GtkWindow |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_OPACITY] = |
| g_param_spec_double ("opacity", |
| P_("Opacity for Widget"), |
| P_("The opacity of the widget, from 0 to 1"), |
| 0.0, 1.0, |
| 1.0, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:overflow: |
| * |
| * How content outside the widget's content area is treated. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_OVERFLOW] = |
| g_param_spec_enum ("overflow", |
| P_("Overflow"), |
| P_("How content outside the widget’s content area is treated"), |
| GTK_TYPE_OVERFLOW, |
| GTK_OVERFLOW_VISIBLE, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE|G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:scale-factor: |
| * |
| * The scale factor of the widget. See gtk_widget_get_scale_factor() for |
| * more details about widget scaling. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_SCALE_FACTOR] = |
| g_param_spec_int ("scale-factor", |
| P_("Scale factor"), |
| P_("The scaling factor of the window"), |
| 1, G_MAXINT, |
| 1, |
| GTK_PARAM_READABLE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:css-name: |
| * |
| * The name of this widget in the CSS tree. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_CSS_NAME] = |
| g_param_spec_string ("css-name", |
| P_("CSS Name"), |
| P_("The name of this widget in the CSS tree"), |
| NULL, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE | G_PARAM_CONSTRUCT_ONLY); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget:layout-manager: |
| * |
| * The #GtkLayoutManager instance to use to compute the preferred size |
| * of the widget, and allocate its children. |
| */ |
| widget_props[PROP_LAYOUT_MANAGER] = |
| g_param_spec_object ("layout-manager", |
| P_("Layout Manager"), |
| P_("The layout manager used to layout children of the widget"), |
| GTK_TYPE_LAYOUT_MANAGER, |
| GTK_PARAM_READWRITE | G_PARAM_EXPLICIT_NOTIFY); |
| |
| g_object_class_install_properties (gobject_class, NUM_PROPERTIES, widget_props); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::destroy: |
| * @object: the object which received the signal |
| * |
| * Signals that all holders of a reference to the widget should release |
| * the reference that they hold. May result in finalization of the widget |
| * if all references are released. |
| * |
| * This signal is not suitable for saving widget state. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DESTROY] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("destroy"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_CLEANUP | G_SIGNAL_NO_RECURSE | G_SIGNAL_NO_HOOKS, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, destroy), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::show: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::show signal is emitted when @widget is shown, for example with |
| * gtk_widget_show(). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[SHOW] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("show"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, show), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::hide: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::hide signal is emitted when @widget is hidden, for example with |
| * gtk_widget_hide(). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[HIDE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("hide"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, hide), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::map: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::map signal is emitted when @widget is going to be mapped, that is |
| * when the widget is visible (which is controlled with |
| * gtk_widget_set_visible()) and all its parents up to the toplevel widget |
| * are also visible. |
| * |
| * The ::map signal can be used to determine whether a widget will be drawn, |
| * for instance it can resume an animation that was stopped during the |
| * emission of #GtkWidget::unmap. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[MAP] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("map"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, map), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::unmap: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::unmap signal is emitted when @widget is going to be unmapped, which |
| * means that either it or any of its parents up to the toplevel widget have |
| * been set as hidden. |
| * |
| * As ::unmap indicates that a widget will not be shown any longer, it can be |
| * used to, for example, stop an animation on the widget. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[UNMAP] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("unmap"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unmap), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::realize: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::realize signal is emitted when @widget is associated with a |
| * #GdkSurface, which means that gtk_widget_realize() has been called or the |
| * widget has been mapped (that is, it is going to be drawn). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[REALIZE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("realize"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, realize), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::unrealize: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::unrealize signal is emitted when the #GdkSurface associated with |
| * @widget is destroyed, which means that gtk_widget_unrealize() has been |
| * called or the widget has been unmapped (that is, it is going to be |
| * hidden). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[UNREALIZE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("unrealize"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, unrealize), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::size-allocate: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * @width: the content width of the widget |
| * @height: the content height of the widget |
| * @baseline: the baseline |
| */ |
| widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("size-allocate"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, size_allocate), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 3, |
| G_TYPE_INT, |
| G_TYPE_INT, |
| G_TYPE_INT); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::state-flags-changed: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * @flags: The previous state flags. |
| * |
| * The ::state-flags-changed signal is emitted when the widget state |
| * changes, see gtk_widget_get_state_flags(). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("state-flags-changed"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, state_flags_changed), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| GTK_TYPE_STATE_FLAGS); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::style-updated: |
| * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted |
| * |
| * The ::style-updated signal is a convenience signal that is emitted when the |
| * #GtkStyleContext::changed signal is emitted on the @widget's associated |
| * #GtkStyleContext as returned by gtk_widget_get_style_context(). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("style-updated"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, style_updated), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__VOID, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::direction-changed: |
| * @widget: the object on which the signal is emitted |
| * @previous_direction: the previous text direction of @widget |
| * |
| * The ::direction-changed signal is emitted when the text direction |
| * of a widget changes. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("direction-changed"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, direction_changed), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| GTK_TYPE_TEXT_DIRECTION); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::grab-notify: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @was_grabbed: %FALSE if the widget becomes shadowed, %TRUE |
| * if it becomes unshadowed |
| * |
| * The ::grab-notify signal is emitted when a widget becomes |
| * shadowed by a GTK+ grab (not a pointer or keyboard grab) on |
| * another widget, or when it becomes unshadowed due to a grab |
| * being removed. |
| * |
| * A widget is shadowed by a gtk_grab_add() when the topmost |
| * grab widget in the grab stack of its window group is not |
| * its ancestor. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("grab-notify"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_FIRST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, grab_notify), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * @group_cycling: %TRUE if there are other widgets with the same mnemonic |
| * |
| * The default handler for this signal activates @widget if @group_cycling |
| * is %FALSE, or just makes @widget grab focus if @group_cycling is %TRUE. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE to stop other handlers from being invoked for the event. |
| * %FALSE to propagate the event further. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("mnemonic-activate"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (gobject_class), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, mnemonic_activate), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__BOOLEAN, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::move-focus: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * @direction: |
| */ |
| widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("move-focus"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, move_focus), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, |
| 1, |
| GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::keynav-failed: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @direction: the direction of movement |
| * |
| * Gets emitted if keyboard navigation fails. |
| * See gtk_widget_keynav_failed() for details. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE |
| * if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard |
| * navigation attempt in its parent widget(s). |
| **/ |
| widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("keynav-failed"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, keynav_failed), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__ENUM, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, |
| GTK_TYPE_DIRECTION_TYPE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-leave: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * @context: the drag context |
| * @time: the timestamp of the motion event |
| * |
| * The ::drag-leave signal is emitted on the drop site when the cursor |
| * leaves the widget. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to |
| * undo things done in #GtkWidget::drag-motion, e.g. undo highlighting |
| * with gtk_drag_unhighlight(). |
| * |
| * |
| * Likewise, the #GtkWidget::drag-leave signal is also emitted before the |
| * ::drag-drop signal, for instance to allow cleaning up of a preview item |
| * created in the #GtkWidget::drag-motion signal handler. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_LEAVE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-leave"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_leave), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| g_cclosure_marshal_VOID__OBJECT, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| GDK_TYPE_DROP); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-begin: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @context: the drag context |
| * |
| * The ::drag-begin signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is |
| * started. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to set up a |
| * custom drag icon with e.g. gtk_drag_source_set_icon_paintable(). |
| * |
| * Note that some widgets set up a drag icon in the default handler of |
| * this signal, so you may have to use g_signal_connect_after() to |
| * override what the default handler did. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_BEGIN] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-begin"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_begin), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| GDK_TYPE_DRAG); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-end: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @context: the drag context |
| * |
| * The ::drag-end signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag is |
| * finished. A typical reason to connect to this signal is to undo |
| * things done in #GtkWidget::drag-begin. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_END] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-end"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_end), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| GDK_TYPE_DRAG); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-data-delete: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @context: the drag context |
| * |
| * The ::drag-data-delete signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag |
| * with the action %GDK_ACTION_MOVE is successfully completed. The signal |
| * handler is responsible for deleting the data that has been dropped. What |
| * "delete" means depends on the context of the drag operation. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_DELETE] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-delete"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_delete), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 1, |
| GDK_TYPE_DRAG); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-failed: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @context: the drag context |
| * @result: the result of the drag operation |
| * |
| * The ::drag-failed signal is emitted on the drag source when a drag has |
| * failed. The signal handler may hook custom code to handle a failed DnD |
| * operation based on the type of error, it returns %TRUE is the failure has |
| * been already handled (not showing the default "drag operation failed" |
| * animation), otherwise it returns %FALSE. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the failed drag operation has been already handled. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_FAILED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-failed"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_failed), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_ENUM, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 2, |
| GDK_TYPE_DRAG, |
| GTK_TYPE_DRAG_RESULT); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-motion: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @drop: the #GdkDrop |
| * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position |
| * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position |
| * |
| * The ::drag-motion signal is emitted on the drop site when the user |
| * moves the cursor over the widget during a drag. The signal handler |
| * must determine whether the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. |
| * If it is not in a drop zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing |
| * is necessary. Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the |
| * handler is responsible for providing the necessary information for |
| * displaying feedback to the user, by calling gdk_drag_status(). |
| * |
| * If the decision whether the drop will be accepted or rejected can't be |
| * made based solely on the cursor position and the type of the data, the |
| * handler may inspect the dragged data by calling gtk_drag_get_data() and |
| * defer the gdk_drag_status() call to the #GtkWidget::drag-data-received |
| * handler. Note that you must pass #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_DROP, |
| * #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_MOTION or #GTK_DEST_DEFAULT_ALL to gtk_drag_dest_set() |
| * when using the drag-motion signal that way. |
| * |
| * Also note that there is no drag-enter signal. The drag receiver has to |
| * keep track of whether he has received any drag-motion signals since the |
| * last #GtkWidget::drag-leave and if not, treat the drag-motion signal as |
| * an "enter" signal. Upon an "enter", the handler will typically highlight |
| * the drop site with gtk_drag_highlight(). |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * static void |
| * drag_motion (GtkWidget *widget, |
| * GdkDrop *drop, |
| * gint x, |
| * gint y, |
| * { |
| * GdkAtom target; |
| * |
| * PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget); |
| * |
| * if (!private_data->drag_highlight) |
| * { |
| * private_data->drag_highlight = 1; |
| * gtk_drag_highlight (widget); |
| * } |
| * |
| * target = gtk_drag_dest_find_target (widget, drop, NULL); |
| * if (target == NULL) |
| * gdk_drop_status (drop, 0); |
| * else |
| * { |
| * private_data->pending_status |
| * = gdk_drop_get_actions (drop); |
| * gtk_drag_get_data (widget, drop, target); |
| * } |
| * |
| * return TRUE; |
| * } |
| * |
| * static void |
| * drag_data_received (GtkWidget *widget, |
| * GdkDrop *drop, |
| * GtkSelectionData *selection_data) |
| * { |
| * PrivateData *private_data = GET_PRIVATE_DATA (widget); |
| * |
| * if (private_data->suggested_action) |
| * { |
| * private_data->suggested_action = 0; |
| * |
| * // We are getting this data due to a request in drag_motion, |
| * // rather than due to a request in drag_drop, so we are just |
| * // supposed to call gdk_drag_status(), not actually paste in |
| * // the data. |
| * |
| * str = gtk_selection_data_get_text (selection_data); |
| * if (!data_is_acceptable (str)) |
| * gdk_drop_status (drop, 0); |
| * else |
| * gdk_drag_status (drop, GDK_ACTION_ALL); |
| * } |
| * else |
| * { |
| * // accept the drop |
| * } |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * Returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_MOTION] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-motion"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_motion), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 3, |
| GDK_TYPE_DROP, |
| G_TYPE_INT, |
| G_TYPE_INT); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-drop: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @drop: the #GdkDrop |
| * @x: the x coordinate of the current cursor position |
| * @y: the y coordinate of the current cursor position |
| * |
| * The ::drag-drop signal is emitted on the drop site when the user drops |
| * the data onto the widget. The signal handler must determine whether |
| * the cursor position is in a drop zone or not. If it is not in a drop |
| * zone, it returns %FALSE and no further processing is necessary. |
| * Otherwise, the handler returns %TRUE. In this case, the handler must |
| * ensure that gdk_drag_finish() is called to let the source know that |
| * the drop is done. The call to gdk_drag_finish() can be done either |
| * directly or in a #GtkWidget::drag-data-received handler which gets |
| * triggered by calling gtk_drag_get_data() to receive the data for one |
| * or more of the supported targets. |
| * |
| * Returns: whether the cursor position is in a drop zone |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_DROP] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-drop"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_drop), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__OBJECT_INT_INT, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 3, |
| GDK_TYPE_DROP, |
| G_TYPE_INT, |
| G_TYPE_INT); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-data-get: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @context: the drag context |
| * @data: the #GtkSelectionData to be filled with the dragged data |
| * @info: the info that has been registered with the target in the |
| * #GtkTargetList |
| * |
| * The ::drag-data-get signal is emitted on the drag source when the drop |
| * site requests the data which is dragged. It is the responsibility of |
| * the signal handler to fill @data with the data in the format which |
| * is indicated by @info. See gtk_selection_data_set() and |
| * gtk_selection_data_set_text(). |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_GET] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-get"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_get), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_BOXED, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 2, |
| GDK_TYPE_DRAG, |
| GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::drag-data-received: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @drop: the #GdkDrop |
| * @x: where the drop happened |
| * @y: where the drop happened |
| * @data: the received data |
| * |
| * The ::drag-data-received signal is emitted on the drop site when the |
| * dragged data has been received. If the data was received in order to |
| * determine whether the drop will be accepted, the handler is expected |
| * to call gdk_drag_status() and not finish the drag. |
| * If the data was received in response to a #GtkWidget::drag-drop signal |
| * (and this is the last target to be received), the handler for this |
| * signal is expected to process the received data and then call |
| * gdk_drag_finish(), setting the @success parameter depending on |
| * whether the data was processed successfully. |
| * |
| * Applications must create some means to determine why the signal was emitted |
| * and therefore whether to call gdk_drag_status() or gdk_drag_finish(). |
| * |
| * The handler may inspect the selected action with |
| * gdk_drag_context_get_selected_action() before calling |
| * gdk_drag_finish(), e.g. to implement %GDK_ACTION_ASK as |
| * shown in the following example: |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * void |
| * drag_data_received (GtkWidget *widget, |
| * GdkDrop *drop, |
| * GtkSelectionData *data) |
| * { |
| * if ((data->length >= 0) && (data->format == 8)) |
| * { |
| * GdkDragAction action; |
| * |
| * // handle data here |
| * |
| * action = gdk_drop_get_actions (drop); |
| * if (!gdk_drag_action_is_unique (action)) |
| * { |
| * GtkWidget *dialog; |
| * gint response; |
| * |
| * dialog = gtk_message_dialog_new (NULL, |
| * GTK_DIALOG_MODAL | |
| * GTK_DIALOG_DESTROY_WITH_PARENT, |
| * GTK_MESSAGE_INFO, |
| * GTK_BUTTONS_YES_NO, |
| * "Move the data ?\n"); |
| * response = gtk_dialog_run (GTK_DIALOG (dialog)); |
| * gtk_widget_destroy (dialog); |
| * |
| * if (response == GTK_RESPONSE_YES) |
| * action = GDK_ACTION_MOVE; |
| * else |
| * action = GDK_ACTION_COPY; |
| * } |
| * |
| * gdk_drop_finish (context, action); |
| * } |
| * else |
| * gdk_drop_finish (context, 0); |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| */ |
| widget_signals[DRAG_DATA_RECEIVED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("drag-data-received"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, drag_data_received), |
| NULL, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_VOID__OBJECT_BOXED, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 2, |
| GDK_TYPE_DROP, |
| GTK_TYPE_SELECTION_DATA | G_SIGNAL_TYPE_STATIC_SCOPE); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::query-tooltip: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @x: the x coordinate of the cursor position where the request has |
| * been emitted, relative to @widget's left side |
| * @y: the y coordinate of the cursor position where the request has |
| * been emitted, relative to @widget's top |
| * @keyboard_mode: %TRUE if the tooltip was triggered using the keyboard |
| * @tooltip: a #GtkTooltip |
| * |
| * Emitted when #GtkWidget:has-tooltip is %TRUE and the hover timeout |
| * has expired with the cursor hovering "above" @widget; or emitted when @widget got |
| * focus in keyboard mode. |
| * |
| * Using the given coordinates, the signal handler should determine |
| * whether a tooltip should be shown for @widget. If this is the case |
| * %TRUE should be returned, %FALSE otherwise. Note that if |
| * @keyboard_mode is %TRUE, the values of @x and @y are undefined and |
| * should not be used. |
| * |
| * The signal handler is free to manipulate @tooltip with the therefore |
| * destined function calls. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @tooltip should be shown right now, %FALSE otherwise. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[QUERY_TOOLTIP] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("query-tooltip"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, query_tooltip), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__INT_INT_BOOLEAN_OBJECT, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 4, |
| G_TYPE_INT, |
| G_TYPE_INT, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, |
| GTK_TYPE_TOOLTIP); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::popup-menu: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * |
| * This signal gets emitted whenever a widget should pop up a context |
| * menu. This usually happens through the standard key binding mechanism; |
| * by pressing a certain key while a widget is focused, the user can cause |
| * the widget to pop up a menu. For example, the #GtkEntry widget creates |
| * a menu with clipboard commands. See the |
| * [Popup Menu Migration Checklist][checklist-popup-menu] |
| * for an example of how to use this signal. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if a menu was activated |
| */ |
| widget_signals[POPUP_MENU] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("popup-menu"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST | G_SIGNAL_ACTION, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, popup_menu), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__VOID, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::accel-closures-changed: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal. |
| * |
| * The ::accel-closures-changed signal gets emitted when accelerators for this |
| * widget get added, removed or changed. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("accel-closures-changed"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| 0, |
| 0, |
| NULL, NULL, |
| NULL, |
| G_TYPE_NONE, 0); |
| |
| /** |
| * GtkWidget::can-activate-accel: |
| * @widget: the object which received the signal |
| * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget |
| * |
| * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal |
| * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated. |
| * This signal is present to allow applications and derived |
| * widgets to override the default #GtkWidget handling |
| * for determining whether an accelerator can be activated. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the signal can be activated. |
| */ |
| widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL] = |
| g_signal_new (I_("can-activate-accel"), |
| G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (klass), |
| G_SIGNAL_RUN_LAST, |
| G_STRUCT_OFFSET (GtkWidgetClass, can_activate_accel), |
| _gtk_boolean_handled_accumulator, NULL, |
| _gtk_marshal_BOOLEAN__UINT, |
| G_TYPE_BOOLEAN, 1, G_TYPE_UINT); |
| |
| binding_set = gtk_binding_set_by_class (klass); |
| gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_F10, GDK_SHIFT_MASK, |
| "popup-menu", 0); |
| gtk_binding_entry_add_signal (binding_set, GDK_KEY_Menu, 0, |
| "popup-menu", 0); |
| |
| gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type (klass, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET_ACCESSIBLE); |
| gtk_widget_class_set_css_name (klass, I_("widget")); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_base_class_finalize (GtkWidgetClass *klass) |
| { |
| template_data_free (klass->priv->template); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_property (GObject *object, |
| guint prop_id, |
| const GValue *value, |
| GParamSpec *pspec) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| switch (prop_id) |
| { |
| gboolean tmp; |
| gchar *tooltip_markup; |
| const gchar *tooltip_text; |
| GtkWindow *tooltip_window; |
| |
| case PROP_NAME: |
| gtk_widget_set_name (widget, g_value_get_string (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST: |
| gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, g_value_get_int (value), -2); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST: |
| gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, -2, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VISIBLE: |
| gtk_widget_set_visible (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_SENSITIVE: |
| gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CAN_FOCUS: |
| gtk_widget_set_can_focus (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HAS_FOCUS: |
| if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) |
| gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); |
| break; |
| case PROP_IS_FOCUS: |
| if (g_value_get_boolean (value)) |
| gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CAN_TARGET: |
| gtk_widget_set_can_target (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK: |
| gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT: |
| gtk_widget_set_receives_default (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CURSOR: |
| gtk_widget_set_cursor (widget, g_value_get_object (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP: |
| gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP: |
| tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window); |
| tooltip_markup = g_value_dup_string (value); |
| |
| /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string, |
| * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip: |
| */ |
| if (tooltip_markup && (strlen (tooltip_markup) == 0)) |
| { |
| g_free (tooltip_markup); |
| tooltip_markup = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup, |
| tooltip_markup, g_free); |
| |
| tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); |
| gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp); |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (widget); |
| break; |
| case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT: |
| tooltip_window = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_window); |
| |
| tooltip_text = g_value_get_string (value); |
| |
| /* Treat an empty string as a NULL string, |
| * because an empty string would be useless for a tooltip: |
| */ |
| if (tooltip_text && (strlen (tooltip_text) == 0)) |
| tooltip_text = NULL; |
| |
| tooltip_markup = tooltip_text ? g_markup_escape_text (tooltip_text, -1) : NULL; |
| |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (object, quark_tooltip_markup, |
| tooltip_markup, g_free); |
| |
| tmp = (tooltip_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); |
| gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (widget, tmp); |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (widget); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HALIGN: |
| gtk_widget_set_halign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VALIGN: |
| gtk_widget_set_valign (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_START: |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_start (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_END: |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_end (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_TOP: |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM: |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN: |
| g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_start (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_end (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_top (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (widget, g_value_get_int (value)); |
| g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HEXPAND: |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HEXPAND_SET: |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VEXPAND: |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VEXPAND_SET: |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_EXPAND: |
| g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand (widget, g_value_get_boolean (value)); |
| g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_OPACITY: |
| gtk_widget_set_opacity (widget, g_value_get_double (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_OVERFLOW: |
| gtk_widget_set_overflow (widget, g_value_get_enum (value)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CSS_NAME: |
| if (g_value_get_string (value) != NULL) |
| gtk_css_node_set_name (priv->cssnode, g_intern_string (g_value_get_string (value))); |
| else |
| gtk_css_node_set_name (priv->cssnode, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->priv->css_name); |
| break; |
| case PROP_LAYOUT_MANAGER: |
| gtk_widget_set_layout_manager (widget, g_value_get_object (value)); |
| break; |
| default: |
| G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_get_property (GObject *object, |
| guint prop_id, |
| GValue *value, |
| GParamSpec *pspec) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| switch (prop_id) |
| { |
| case PROP_NAME: |
| if (priv->name) |
| g_value_set_string (value, priv->name); |
| else |
| g_value_set_static_string (value, ""); |
| break; |
| case PROP_PARENT: |
| g_value_set_object (value, priv->parent); |
| break; |
| case PROP_ROOT: |
| g_value_set_object (value, priv->root); |
| break; |
| case PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST: |
| { |
| int w; |
| gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, &w, NULL); |
| g_value_set_int (value, w); |
| } |
| break; |
| case PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST: |
| { |
| int h; |
| gtk_widget_get_size_request (widget, NULL, &h); |
| g_value_set_int (value, h); |
| } |
| break; |
| case PROP_VISIBLE: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_SENSITIVE: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_sensitive (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CAN_FOCUS: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HAS_FOCUS: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_has_focus (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_IS_FOCUS: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_is_focus (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CAN_TARGET: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_can_target (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_focus_on_click (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HAS_DEFAULT: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_has_default (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_receives_default (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CURSOR: |
| g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_cursor (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_TOOLTIP_TEXT: |
| { |
| gchar *escaped = g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup); |
| gchar *text = NULL; |
| |
| if (escaped && !pango_parse_markup (escaped, -1, 0, NULL, &text, NULL, NULL)) |
| g_assert (NULL == text); /* text should still be NULL in case of markup errors */ |
| |
| g_value_take_string (value, text); |
| } |
| break; |
| case PROP_TOOLTIP_MARKUP: |
| g_value_set_string (value, g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_tooltip_markup)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_SURFACE: |
| g_value_set_object (value, _gtk_widget_get_surface (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HALIGN: |
| g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_halign (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VALIGN: |
| g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_valign (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_START: |
| g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_start (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_END: |
| g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_end (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_TOP: |
| g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_top (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM: |
| g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_MARGIN: |
| g_value_set_int (value, MAX (MAX (priv->margin.left, |
| priv->margin.right), |
| MAX (priv->margin.top, |
| priv->margin.bottom))); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HEXPAND: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_HEXPAND_SET: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VEXPAND: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_VEXPAND_SET: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_EXPAND: |
| g_value_set_boolean (value, |
| gtk_widget_get_hexpand (widget) && |
| gtk_widget_get_vexpand (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_OPACITY: |
| g_value_set_double (value, gtk_widget_get_opacity (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_OVERFLOW: |
| g_value_set_enum (value, gtk_widget_get_overflow (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_SCALE_FACTOR: |
| g_value_set_int (value, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_CSS_NAME: |
| g_value_set_string (value, gtk_css_node_get_name (priv->cssnode)); |
| break; |
| case PROP_LAYOUT_MANAGER: |
| g_value_set_object (value, gtk_widget_get_layout_manager (widget)); |
| break; |
| default: |
| G_OBJECT_WARN_INVALID_PROPERTY_ID (object, prop_id, pspec); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| _gtk_widget_emulate_press (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GdkEvent *event) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *event_widget, *next_child, *parent; |
| GdkEvent *press; |
| gdouble x, y; |
| graphene_point_t p; |
| |
| event_widget = gtk_get_event_target ((GdkEvent *) event); |
| |
| if (event_widget == widget) |
| return; |
| |
| gdk_event_get_coords (event, &x, &y); |
| if (!gtk_widget_compute_point (event_widget, |
| gtk_widget_get_toplevel (event_widget), |
| &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (x, y), |
| &p)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN || |
| event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_UPDATE || |
| event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_END) |
| { |
| press = gdk_event_copy (event); |
| press->any.type = GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN; |
| } |
| else if (event->any.type == GDK_BUTTON_PRESS || |
| event->any.type == GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE) |
| { |
| press = gdk_event_copy (event); |
| press->any.type = GDK_BUTTON_PRESS; |
| } |
| else if (event->any.type == GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY) |
| { |
| press = gdk_event_new (GDK_BUTTON_PRESS); |
| press->any.surface = g_object_ref (event->any.surface); |
| press->button.time = event->motion.time; |
| press->button.x_root = event->motion.x_root; |
| press->button.y_root = event->motion.y_root; |
| press->button.state = event->motion.state; |
| |
| press->button.axes = g_memdup (event->motion.axes, |
| sizeof (gdouble) * |
| gdk_device_get_n_axes (event->any.device)); |
| |
| if (event->motion.state & GDK_BUTTON3_MASK) |
| press->button.button = 3; |
| else if (event->motion.state & GDK_BUTTON2_MASK) |
| press->button.button = 2; |
| else |
| { |
| if ((event->motion.state & GDK_BUTTON1_MASK) == 0) |
| g_critical ("Guessing button number 1 on generated button press event"); |
| |
| press->button.button = 1; |
| } |
| |
| gdk_event_set_device (press, gdk_event_get_device (event)); |
| gdk_event_set_source_device (press, gdk_event_get_source_device (event)); |
| } |
| else |
| return; |
| |
| gdk_event_set_coords (press, p.x, p.y); |
| |
| press->any.send_event = TRUE; |
| next_child = event_widget; |
| parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (next_child); |
| |
| while (parent && parent != widget) |
| { |
| next_child = parent; |
| parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); |
| } |
| |
| /* Perform propagation state starting from the next child in the chain */ |
| gtk_propagate_event_internal (event_widget, press, next_child); |
| g_object_unref (press); |
| } |
| |
| static const GdkEvent * |
| _gtk_widget_get_last_event (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkEventController *controller; |
| const GdkEvent *event; |
| GList *l; |
| |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| continue; |
| |
| event = gtk_gesture_get_last_event (GTK_GESTURE (controller), |
| sequence); |
| if (event) |
| return event; |
| } |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| _gtk_widget_get_emulating_sequence (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence, |
| GdkEventSequence **sequence_out) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| *sequence_out = sequence; |
| |
| if (sequence) |
| { |
| const GdkEvent *last_event; |
| |
| last_event = _gtk_widget_get_last_event (widget, sequence); |
| |
| if (last_event && |
| (last_event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_BEGIN || |
| last_event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_UPDATE || |
| last_event->any.type == GDK_TOUCH_END) && |
| last_event->touch.emulating_pointer) |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* For a NULL(pointer) sequence, find the pointer emulating one */ |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (_gtk_gesture_get_pointer_emulating_sequence (GTK_GESTURE (controller), |
| sequence_out)) |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_needs_press_emulation (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gboolean sequence_press_handled = FALSE; |
| GList *l; |
| |
| /* Check whether there is any remaining gesture in |
| * the capture phase that handled the press event |
| */ |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| GtkPropagationPhase phase; |
| GtkGesture *gesture; |
| |
| phase = gtk_event_controller_get_propagation_phase (controller); |
| |
| if (phase != GTK_PHASE_CAPTURE) |
| continue; |
| if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| continue; |
| |
| gesture = GTK_GESTURE (controller); |
| sequence_press_handled |= |
| (gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, sequence) && |
| _gtk_gesture_handled_sequence_press (gesture, sequence)); |
| } |
| |
| return !sequence_press_handled; |
| } |
| |
| static gint |
| _gtk_widget_set_sequence_state_internal (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence, |
| GtkEventSequenceState state, |
| GtkGesture *emitter) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gboolean emulates_pointer, sequence_handled = FALSE; |
| const GdkEvent *mimic_event; |
| GList *group = NULL, *l; |
| GdkEventSequence *seq; |
| gint n_handled = 0; |
| |
| if (!priv->event_controllers && state != GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| if (emitter) |
| group = gtk_gesture_get_group (emitter); |
| |
| emulates_pointer = _gtk_widget_get_emulating_sequence (widget, sequence, &seq); |
| mimic_event = _gtk_widget_get_last_event (widget, seq); |
| |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventSequenceState gesture_state; |
| GtkEventController *controller; |
| GtkGesture *gesture; |
| gboolean retval; |
| |
| seq = sequence; |
| controller = l->data; |
| gesture_state = state; |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| continue; |
| |
| gesture = GTK_GESTURE (controller); |
| |
| if (gesture == emitter) |
| { |
| sequence_handled |= |
| _gtk_gesture_handled_sequence_press (gesture, sequence); |
| n_handled++; |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| if (seq && emulates_pointer && |
| !gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, seq)) |
| seq = NULL; |
| |
| if (group && !g_list_find (group, controller)) |
| { |
| /* If a group is provided, ensure only gestures pertaining to the group |
| * get a "claimed" state, all other claiming gestures must deny the sequence. |
| */ |
| if (gesture_state == GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED && |
| gtk_gesture_get_sequence_state (gesture, sequence) == GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) |
| gesture_state = GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_DENIED; |
| else |
| continue; |
| } |
| else if (!group && |
| gtk_gesture_get_sequence_state (gesture, sequence) != GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) |
| continue; |
| |
| retval = gtk_gesture_set_sequence_state (gesture, seq, gesture_state); |
| |
| if (retval || gesture == emitter) |
| { |
| sequence_handled |= |
| _gtk_gesture_handled_sequence_press (gesture, seq); |
| n_handled++; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* If the sequence goes denied, check whether this is a controller attached |
| * to the capture phase, that additionally handled the button/touch press (i.e. |
| * it was consumed), the corresponding press will be emulated for widgets |
| * beneath, so the widgets beneath get a coherent stream of events from now on. |
| */ |
| if (n_handled > 0 && sequence_handled && |
| state == GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_DENIED && |
| gtk_widget_needs_press_emulation (widget, sequence)) |
| _gtk_widget_emulate_press (widget, mimic_event); |
| |
| g_list_free (group); |
| |
| return n_handled; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| _gtk_widget_cancel_sequence (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gboolean emulates_pointer; |
| gboolean handled = FALSE; |
| GdkEventSequence *seq; |
| GList *l; |
| |
| emulates_pointer = _gtk_widget_get_emulating_sequence (widget, sequence, &seq); |
| |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller; |
| GtkGesture *gesture; |
| |
| seq = sequence; |
| controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| continue; |
| |
| gesture = GTK_GESTURE (controller); |
| |
| if (seq && emulates_pointer && |
| !gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, seq)) |
| seq = NULL; |
| |
| if (!gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (gesture, seq)) |
| continue; |
| |
| handled |= _gtk_gesture_cancel_sequence (gesture, seq); |
| } |
| |
| return handled; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_init (GTypeInstance *instance, gpointer g_class) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (instance); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GType layout_manager_type; |
| |
| widget->priv = priv; |
| |
| priv->visible = gtk_widget_class_get_visible_by_default (g_class); |
| priv->child_visible = TRUE; |
| priv->name = NULL; |
| priv->user_alpha = 255; |
| priv->alpha = 255; |
| priv->surface = NULL; |
| priv->parent = NULL; |
| priv->first_child = NULL; |
| priv->last_child = NULL; |
| priv->prev_sibling = NULL; |
| priv->next_sibling = NULL; |
| priv->baseline = -1; |
| priv->allocated_size_baseline = -1; |
| |
| priv->sensitive = TRUE; |
| priv->alloc_needed = TRUE; |
| priv->alloc_needed_on_child = TRUE; |
| priv->draw_needed = TRUE; |
| priv->focus_on_click = TRUE; |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG |
| priv->highlight_resize = FALSE; |
| #endif |
| priv->can_target = TRUE; |
| |
| switch (_gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)) |
| { |
| case GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR: |
| priv->state_flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR; |
| break; |
| |
| case GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL: |
| priv->state_flags = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL; |
| break; |
| |
| case GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE: |
| default: |
| g_assert_not_reached (); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| /* this will be set to TRUE if the widget gets a child or if the |
| * expand flag is set on the widget, but until one of those happen |
| * we know the expand is already properly FALSE. |
| * |
| * We really want to default FALSE here to avoid computing expand |
| * all over the place while initially building a widget tree. |
| */ |
| priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE; |
| |
| priv->halign = GTK_ALIGN_FILL; |
| priv->valign = GTK_ALIGN_FILL; |
| |
| priv->width_request = -1; |
| priv->height_request = -1; |
| |
| _gtk_size_request_cache_init (&priv->requests); |
| |
| priv->cssnode = gtk_css_widget_node_new (widget); |
| gtk_css_node_set_state (priv->cssnode, priv->state_flags); |
| gtk_css_node_set_visible (priv->cssnode, priv->visible); |
| /* need to set correct type here, and only class has the correct type here */ |
| gtk_css_node_set_widget_type (priv->cssnode, G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (g_class)); |
| |
| if (g_type_is_a (G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (g_class), GTK_TYPE_ROOT)) |
| priv->root = (GtkRoot *) widget; |
| |
| layout_manager_type = gtk_widget_class_get_layout_manager_type (g_class); |
| if (layout_manager_type != G_TYPE_INVALID) |
| gtk_widget_set_layout_manager (widget, g_object_new (layout_manager_type, NULL)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_new: |
| * @type: type ID of the widget to create |
| * @first_property_name: name of first property to set |
| * @...: value of first property, followed by more properties, |
| * %NULL-terminated |
| * |
| * This is a convenience function for creating a widget and setting |
| * its properties in one go. For example you might write: |
| * `gtk_widget_new (GTK_TYPE_LABEL, "label", "Hello World", "xalign", |
| * 0.0, NULL)` to create a left-aligned label. Equivalent to |
| * g_object_new(), but returns a widget so you don’t have to |
| * cast the object yourself. |
| * |
| * Returns: a new #GtkWidget of type @widget_type |
| **/ |
| GtkWidget* |
| gtk_widget_new (GType type, |
| const gchar *first_property_name, |
| ...) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget; |
| va_list var_args; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, GTK_TYPE_WIDGET), NULL); |
| |
| va_start (var_args, first_property_name); |
| widget = (GtkWidget *)g_object_new_valist (type, first_property_name, var_args); |
| va_end (var_args); |
| |
| return widget; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_root (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_assert (!priv->realized); |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| { |
| g_assert (priv->root == GTK_ROOT (widget)); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| g_assert (priv->root == NULL); |
| priv->root = priv->parent->priv->root; |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_display (priv->context, gtk_root_get_display (priv->root)); |
| |
| if (priv->surface_transform_data) |
| add_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (widget); |
| |
| GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->root (widget); |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_ROOT]); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_unroot (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data; |
| |
| g_assert (priv->root); |
| g_assert (!priv->realized); |
| |
| surface_transform_data = priv->surface_transform_data; |
| if (surface_transform_data && |
| surface_transform_data->tracked_parent) |
| remove_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (widget); |
| |
| GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->unroot (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_display (priv->context, gdk_display_get_default ()); |
| |
| if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context)) |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context, NULL); |
| |
| _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| { |
| priv->root = NULL; |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_ROOT]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_unparent: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function is only for use in widget implementations. |
| * Should be called by parent widgets to dissociate @widget |
| * from the parent. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_unparent (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidget *old_parent; |
| GtkWidget *old_prev_sibling; |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->parent == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_detach() */ |
| |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| |
| toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) |
| _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); |
| |
| if (gtk_widget_get_focus_child (priv->parent) == widget) |
| gtk_widget_set_focus_child (priv->parent, NULL); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_is_drawable (priv->parent)) |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (priv->parent); |
| |
| if (priv->visible && _gtk_widget_get_visible (priv->parent)) |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (priv->parent); |
| |
| /* Reset the width and height here, to force reallocation if we |
| * get added back to a new parent. |
| */ |
| priv->width = 0; |
| priv->height = 0; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_unrealize (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->root) |
| gtk_widget_unroot (widget); |
| |
| toplevel = NULL; |
| |
| /* Removing a widget from a container restores the child visible |
| * flag to the default state, so it doesn't affect the child |
| * in the next parent. |
| */ |
| priv->child_visible = TRUE; |
| |
| old_parent = priv->parent; |
| if (old_parent) |
| { |
| if (old_parent->priv->first_child == widget) |
| old_parent->priv->first_child = priv->next_sibling; |
| |
| if (old_parent->priv->last_child == widget) |
| old_parent->priv->last_child = priv->prev_sibling; |
| |
| if (priv->prev_sibling) |
| priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = priv->next_sibling; |
| if (priv->next_sibling) |
| priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; |
| } |
| old_prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; |
| priv->parent = NULL; |
| priv->prev_sibling = NULL; |
| priv->next_sibling = NULL; |
| |
| /* parent may no longer expand if the removed |
| * child was expand=TRUE and could therefore |
| * be forcing it to. |
| */ |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && |
| (priv->need_compute_expand || |
| priv->computed_hexpand || |
| priv->computed_vexpand)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (old_parent); |
| } |
| |
| /* Unset BACKDROP since we are no longer inside a toplevel window */ |
| gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (widget, GTK_STATE_FLAG_BACKDROP); |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_parent (priv->context, NULL); |
| gtk_css_node_set_parent (priv->cssnode, NULL); |
| |
| _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (widget); |
| |
| if (old_parent->priv->children_observer) |
| gtk_list_list_model_item_removed (old_parent->priv->children_observer, old_prev_sibling); |
| |
| if (old_parent->priv->layout_manager) |
| gtk_layout_manager_remove_layout_child (old_parent->priv->layout_manager, widget); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_PARENT]); |
| g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_destroy: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Destroys a widget. |
| * |
| * When a widget is destroyed all references it holds on other objects |
| * will be released: |
| * |
| * - if the widget is inside a container, it will be removed from its |
| * parent |
| * - if the widget is a container, all its children will be destroyed, |
| * recursively |
| * - if the widget is a top level, it will be removed from the list |
| * of top level widgets that GTK+ maintains internally |
| * |
| * It's expected that all references held on the widget will also |
| * be released; you should connect to the #GtkWidget::destroy signal |
| * if you hold a reference to @widget and you wish to remove it when |
| * this function is called. It is not necessary to do so if you are |
| * implementing a #GtkContainer, as you'll be able to use the |
| * #GtkContainerClass.remove() virtual function for that. |
| * |
| * It's important to notice that gtk_widget_destroy() will only cause |
| * the @widget to be finalized if no additional references, acquired |
| * using g_object_ref(), are held on it. In case additional references |
| * are in place, the @widget will be in an "inert" state after calling |
| * this function; @widget will still point to valid memory, allowing you |
| * to release the references you hold, but you may not query the widget's |
| * own state. |
| * |
| * You should typically call this function on top level widgets, and |
| * rarely on child widgets. |
| * |
| * See also: gtk_container_remove() |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_destroy (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (!priv->in_destruction) |
| g_object_run_dispose (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_destroyed: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @widget_pointer: (inout) (transfer none): address of a variable that contains @widget |
| * |
| * This function sets *@widget_pointer to %NULL if @widget_pointer != |
| * %NULL. It’s intended to be used as a callback connected to the |
| * “destroy” signal of a widget. You connect gtk_widget_destroyed() |
| * as a signal handler, and pass the address of your widget variable |
| * as user data. Then when the widget is destroyed, the variable will |
| * be set to %NULL. Useful for example to avoid multiple copies |
| * of the same dialog. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_destroyed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget **widget_pointer) |
| { |
| /* Don't make any assumptions about the |
| * value of widget! |
| * Even check widget_pointer. |
| */ |
| if (widget_pointer) |
| *widget_pointer = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_show: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Flags a widget to be displayed. Any widget that isn’t shown will |
| * not appear on the screen. |
| * |
| * Remember that you have to show the containers containing a widget, |
| * in addition to the widget itself, before it will appear onscreen. |
| * |
| * When a toplevel container is shown, it is immediately realized and |
| * mapped; other shown widgets are realized and mapped when their |
| * toplevel container is realized and mapped. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_show (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); |
| if (parent) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (parent); |
| |
| /* see comment in set_parent() for why this should and can be |
| * conditional |
| */ |
| if (priv->need_compute_expand || |
| priv->computed_hexpand || |
| priv->computed_vexpand) |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (parent); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_css_node_set_visible (priv->cssnode, TRUE); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SHOW], 0); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_VISIBLE]); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_show (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| { |
| priv->visible = TRUE; |
| |
| if (priv->parent && |
| _gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) && |
| !_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_map (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_hide: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Reverses the effects of gtk_widget_show(), causing the widget to be |
| * hidden (invisible to the user). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_hide (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| if (toplevel != widget && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) |
| _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); |
| |
| /* a parent may now be expand=FALSE since we're hidden. */ |
| if (priv->need_compute_expand || |
| priv->computed_hexpand || |
| priv->computed_vexpand) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_css_node_set_visible (priv->cssnode, FALSE); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[HIDE], 0); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_VISIBLE]); |
| |
| parent = gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); |
| if (parent) |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (parent); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_hide (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| { |
| priv->visible = FALSE; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_unmap (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| update_cursor_on_state_change (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| |
| toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| if (!GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_window_update_pointer_focus_on_state_change (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), |
| widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_map: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes |
| * a widget to be mapped if it isn’t already. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_map (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget)); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_realize (widget); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[MAP], 0); |
| |
| update_cursor_on_state_change (widget); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_unmap: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function is only for use in widget implementations. Causes |
| * a widget to be unmapped if it’s currently mapped. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_unmap (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| { |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| _gtk_tooltip_hide (widget); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNMAP], 0); |
| |
| update_cursor_on_state_change (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| typedef struct _GtkTickCallbackInfo GtkTickCallbackInfo; |
| |
| struct _GtkTickCallbackInfo |
| { |
| guint refcount; |
| |
| guint id; |
| GtkTickCallback callback; |
| gpointer user_data; |
| GDestroyNotify notify; |
| |
| guint destroyed : 1; |
| }; |
| |
| static void |
| ref_tick_callback_info (GtkTickCallbackInfo *info) |
| { |
| info->refcount++; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| unref_tick_callback_info (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTickCallbackInfo *info, |
| GList *link) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| info->refcount--; |
| if (info->refcount == 0) |
| { |
| priv->tick_callbacks = g_list_delete_link (priv->tick_callbacks, link); |
| if (info->notify) |
| info->notify (info->user_data); |
| g_slice_free (GtkTickCallbackInfo, info); |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->tick_callbacks == NULL && priv->clock_tick_id) |
| { |
| GdkFrameClock *frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); |
| g_signal_handler_disconnect (frame_clock, priv->clock_tick_id); |
| priv->clock_tick_id = 0; |
| gdk_frame_clock_end_updating (frame_clock); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| destroy_tick_callback_info (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTickCallbackInfo *info, |
| GList *link) |
| { |
| if (!info->destroyed) |
| { |
| info->destroyed = TRUE; |
| unref_tick_callback_info (widget, info, link); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| destroy_tick_callbacks (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| for (l = priv->tick_callbacks; l;) |
| { |
| GList *next = l->next; |
| destroy_tick_callback_info (widget, l->data, l); |
| l = next; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update (GdkFrameClock *frame_clock, |
| GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| |
| for (l = priv->tick_callbacks; l;) |
| { |
| GtkTickCallbackInfo *info = l->data; |
| GList *next; |
| |
| ref_tick_callback_info (info); |
| if (!info->destroyed) |
| { |
| if (info->callback (widget, |
| frame_clock, |
| info->user_data) == G_SOURCE_REMOVE) |
| { |
| destroy_tick_callback_info (widget, info, l); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| next = l->next; |
| unref_tick_callback_info (widget, info, l); |
| l = next; |
| } |
| |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static guint tick_callback_id; |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_add_tick_callback: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @callback: function to call for updating animations |
| * @user_data: data to pass to @callback |
| * @notify: function to call to free @user_data when the callback is removed. |
| * |
| * Queues an animation frame update and adds a callback to be called |
| * before each frame. Until the tick callback is removed, it will be |
| * called frequently (usually at the frame rate of the output device |
| * or as quickly as the application can be repainted, whichever is |
| * slower). For this reason, is most suitable for handling graphics |
| * that change every frame or every few frames. The tick callback does |
| * not automatically imply a relayout or repaint. If you want a |
| * repaint or relayout, and aren’t changing widget properties that |
| * would trigger that (for example, changing the text of a #GtkLabel), |
| * then you will have to call gtk_widget_queue_resize() or |
| * gtk_widget_queue_draw() yourself. |
| * |
| * gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time() should generally be used for timing |
| * continuous animations and |
| * gdk_frame_timings_get_predicted_presentation_time() if you are |
| * trying to display isolated frames at particular times. |
| * |
| * This is a more convenient alternative to connecting directly to the |
| * #GdkFrameClock::update signal of #GdkFrameClock, since you don't |
| * have to worry about when a #GdkFrameClock is assigned to a widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: an id for the connection of this callback. Remove the callback |
| * by passing the id returned from this function to |
| * gtk_widget_remove_tick_callback() |
| */ |
| guint |
| gtk_widget_add_tick_callback (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTickCallback callback, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GDestroyNotify notify) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkTickCallbackInfo *info; |
| GdkFrameClock *frame_clock; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| if (priv->realized && !priv->clock_tick_id) |
| { |
| frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); |
| |
| if (frame_clock) |
| { |
| priv->clock_tick_id = g_signal_connect (frame_clock, "update", |
| G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update), |
| widget); |
| gdk_frame_clock_begin_updating (frame_clock); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| info = g_slice_new0 (GtkTickCallbackInfo); |
| |
| info->refcount = 1; |
| info->id = ++tick_callback_id; |
| info->callback = callback; |
| info->user_data = user_data; |
| info->notify = notify; |
| |
| priv->tick_callbacks = g_list_prepend (priv->tick_callbacks, |
| info); |
| |
| return info->id; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_remove_tick_callback: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @id: an id returned by gtk_widget_add_tick_callback() |
| * |
| * Removes a tick callback previously registered with |
| * gtk_widget_add_tick_callback(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_remove_tick_callback (GtkWidget *widget, |
| guint id) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| for (l = priv->tick_callbacks; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkTickCallbackInfo *info = l->data; |
| if (info->id == id) |
| { |
| destroy_tick_callback_info (widget, info, l); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_has_tick_callback (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->tick_callbacks != NULL; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_connect_frame_clock (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GdkFrameClock *frame_clock; |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| gtk_container_start_idle_sizer (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); |
| |
| frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->tick_callbacks != NULL && !priv->clock_tick_id) |
| { |
| priv->clock_tick_id = g_signal_connect (frame_clock, "update", |
| G_CALLBACK (gtk_widget_on_frame_clock_update), |
| widget); |
| gdk_frame_clock_begin_updating (frame_clock); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_css_node_invalidate_frame_clock (priv->cssnode, FALSE); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_disconnect_frame_clock (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| gtk_container_stop_idle_sizer (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_css_node_invalidate_frame_clock (priv->cssnode, FALSE); |
| |
| if (priv->clock_tick_id) |
| { |
| GdkFrameClock *frame_clock; |
| |
| frame_clock = gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (widget); |
| |
| g_signal_handler_disconnect (frame_clock, priv->clock_tick_id); |
| priv->clock_tick_id = 0; |
| gdk_frame_clock_end_updating (frame_clock); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| typedef struct _GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo; |
| |
| struct _GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo |
| { |
| guint id; |
| GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallback callback; |
| gpointer user_data; |
| GDestroyNotify notify; |
| }; |
| |
| static void |
| surface_transform_changed_callback_info_destroy (GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo *info) |
| { |
| if (info->notify) |
| info->notify (info->user_data); |
| |
| g_slice_free (GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo, info); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| notify_surface_transform_changed (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data = |
| priv->surface_transform_data; |
| graphene_matrix_t *surface_transform; |
| GList *l; |
| |
| if (surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid) |
| surface_transform = &surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform; |
| else |
| surface_transform = NULL; |
| |
| for (l = surface_transform_data->callbacks; l;) |
| { |
| GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo *info = l->data; |
| GList *l_next = l->next; |
| |
| if (info->callback (widget, |
| surface_transform, |
| info->user_data) == G_SOURCE_REMOVE) |
| { |
| surface_transform_data->callbacks = |
| g_list_delete_link (surface_transform_data->callbacks, l); |
| surface_transform_changed_callback_info_destroy (info); |
| } |
| |
| l = l_next; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| destroy_surface_transform_data (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data; |
| |
| surface_transform_data = priv->surface_transform_data; |
| if (!surface_transform_data) |
| return; |
| |
| g_list_free_full (surface_transform_data->callbacks, |
| (GDestroyNotify) surface_transform_changed_callback_info_destroy); |
| g_slice_free (GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData, surface_transform_data); |
| priv->surface_transform_data = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| sync_widget_surface_transform (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data = |
| priv->surface_transform_data; |
| gboolean was_valid; |
| graphene_matrix_t prev_transform; |
| |
| was_valid = surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid; |
| prev_transform = surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform; |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| { |
| gsk_transform_to_matrix (priv->transform, |
| &surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform); |
| surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid = TRUE; |
| } |
| else if (!priv->root) |
| { |
| surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid = FALSE; |
| } |
| else if (gtk_widget_compute_transform (widget, GTK_WIDGET (priv->root), |
| &surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform)) |
| { |
| surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| g_warning ("Could not compute surface transform"); |
| surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid = FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| if (was_valid != surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid || |
| (was_valid && surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform_valid && |
| !graphene_matrix_equal (&surface_transform_data->cached_surface_transform, |
| &prev_transform))) |
| notify_surface_transform_changed (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static guint surface_transform_changed_callback_id; |
| |
| static gboolean |
| parent_surface_transform_changed_cb (GtkWidget *parent, |
| const graphene_matrix_t *transform, |
| gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (user_data); |
| |
| sync_widget_surface_transform (widget); |
| |
| return G_SOURCE_CONTINUE; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| remove_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data = |
| priv->surface_transform_data; |
| |
| g_assert (surface_transform_data->tracked_parent); |
| |
| gtk_widget_remove_surface_transform_changed_callback ( |
| surface_transform_data->tracked_parent, |
| surface_transform_data->parent_surface_transform_changed_id); |
| surface_transform_data->parent_surface_transform_changed_id = 0; |
| g_clear_object (&surface_transform_data->tracked_parent); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| add_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data = |
| priv->surface_transform_data; |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| |
| |
| g_assert (!surface_transform_data->tracked_parent); |
| |
| parent = priv->parent; |
| surface_transform_data->parent_surface_transform_changed_id = |
| gtk_widget_add_surface_transform_changed_callback ( |
| parent, |
| parent_surface_transform_changed_cb, |
| widget, |
| NULL); |
| surface_transform_data->tracked_parent = g_object_ref (parent); |
| } |
| |
| static GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData * |
| ensure_surface_transform_data (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!priv->surface_transform_data) |
| priv->surface_transform_data = g_slice_new0 (GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData); |
| |
| return priv->surface_transform_data; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_add_surface_transform_changed_callback: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @callback: a function to call when the surface transform changes |
| * @user_data: data to pass to @callback |
| * @notify: function to call to free @user_data when the callback is removed |
| * |
| * Invokes the callback whenever the surface relative transform of the widget |
| * changes. |
| * |
| * Returns: an id for the connection of this callback. Remove the callback by |
| * passing the id returned from this funcction to |
| * gtk_widget_remove_surface_transform_changed_callback() |
| */ |
| guint |
| gtk_widget_add_surface_transform_changed_callback (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallback callback, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GDestroyNotify notify) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data; |
| GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo *info; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (callback, 0); |
| |
| priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| surface_transform_data = ensure_surface_transform_data (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->parent && |
| !surface_transform_data->parent_surface_transform_changed_id) |
| add_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (widget); |
| |
| if (!surface_transform_data->callbacks) |
| sync_widget_surface_transform (widget); |
| |
| info = g_slice_new0 (GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo); |
| |
| info->id = ++surface_transform_changed_callback_id; |
| info->callback = callback; |
| info->user_data = user_data; |
| info->notify = notify; |
| |
| surface_transform_data->callbacks = |
| g_list_prepend (surface_transform_data->callbacks, info); |
| |
| return info->id; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_remove_surface_transform_changed_callback: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @id: an id returned by gtk_widget_add_surface_transform_changed_callback() |
| * |
| * Removes a surface transform changed callback previously registered with |
| * gtk_widget_add_surface_transform_changed_callback(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_remove_surface_transform_changed_callback (GtkWidget *widget, |
| guint id) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv; |
| GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData *surface_transform_data; |
| GList *l; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (id); |
| |
| priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| surface_transform_data = priv->surface_transform_data; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (surface_transform_data); |
| |
| for (l = surface_transform_data->callbacks; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkSurfaceTransformChangedCallbackInfo *info = l->data; |
| |
| if (info->id == id) |
| { |
| surface_transform_data->callbacks = |
| g_list_delete_link (surface_transform_data->callbacks, l); |
| |
| surface_transform_changed_callback_info_destroy (info); |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!surface_transform_data->callbacks) |
| { |
| if (surface_transform_data->tracked_parent) |
| remove_parent_surface_transform_changed_listener (widget); |
| g_slice_free (GtkWidgetSurfaceTransformData, surface_transform_data); |
| priv->surface_transform_data = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_realize: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Creates the GDK (windowing system) resources associated with a |
| * widget. For example, @widget->surface will be created when a widget |
| * is realized. Normally realization happens implicitly; if you show |
| * a widget and all its parent containers, then the widget will be |
| * realized and mapped automatically. |
| * |
| * Realizing a widget requires all |
| * the widget’s parent widgets to be realized; calling |
| * gtk_widget_realize() realizes the widget’s parents in addition to |
| * @widget itself. If a widget is not yet inside a toplevel window |
| * when you realize it, bad things will happen. |
| * |
| * This function is primarily used in widget implementations, and |
| * isn’t very useful otherwise. Many times when you think you might |
| * need it, a better approach is to connect to a signal that will be |
| * called after the widget is realized automatically, such as |
| * #GtkWidget::realize. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_realize (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| /* |
| if (GTK_IS_CONTAINER (widget) && _gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| g_message ("gtk_widget_realize(%s)", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); |
| */ |
| |
| if (priv->parent == NULL && |
| !_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| g_warning ("Calling gtk_widget_realize() on a widget that isn't " |
| "inside a toplevel window is not going to work very well. " |
| "Widgets must be inside a toplevel container before realizing them."); |
| |
| if (priv->parent && !_gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) |
| gtk_widget_realize (priv->parent); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[REALIZE], 0); |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_input_shape (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->multidevice) |
| gdk_surface_set_support_multidevice (priv->surface, TRUE); |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_alpha (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_scale (priv->context, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_unrealize: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function is only useful in widget implementations. |
| * Causes a widget to be unrealized (frees all GDK resources |
| * associated with the widget, such as @widget->surface). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info)) |
| gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (widget, NULL); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| { |
| if (priv->mapped) |
| gtk_widget_unmap (widget); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[UNREALIZE], 0); |
| g_assert (!priv->mapped); |
| g_assert (!priv->realized); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Returns the values you're supposed to pass to gdk_surface_move_resize |
| * for a windowed widget. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_get_surface_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkAllocation *allocation) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| graphene_rect_t bounds; |
| |
| /* Don't consider the parent == widget case here. */ |
| parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); |
| while (parent && !_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (parent)) |
| parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (parent); |
| |
| g_assert (GTK_IS_WINDOW (parent) || GTK_IS_POPOVER (parent)); |
| |
| if (gtk_widget_compute_bounds (widget, parent, &bounds)) |
| { |
| *allocation = (GtkAllocation){ |
| floorf (bounds.origin.x), |
| floorf (bounds.origin.y), |
| ceilf (bounds.size.width), |
| ceilf (bounds.size.height) |
| }; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| *allocation = (GtkAllocation) { 0, 0, 0, 0 }; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_update_paintables (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| for (l = priv->paintables; l; l = l->next) |
| gtk_widget_paintable_update_image (l->data); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_push_paintables (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| for (l = priv->paintables; l; l = l->next) |
| gtk_widget_paintable_push_snapshot_count (l->data); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_pop_paintables (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| for (l = priv->paintables; l; l = l->next) |
| gtk_widget_paintable_pop_snapshot_count (l->data); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_queue_draw: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Schedules this widget to be redrawn in paint phase of the |
| * current or the next frame. This means @widget's GtkWidgetClass.snapshot() |
| * implementation will be called. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| /* Just return if the widget isn't mapped */ |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| return; |
| |
| for (; widget; widget = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->draw_needed) |
| break; |
| |
| priv->draw_needed = TRUE; |
| g_clear_pointer (&priv->render_node, gsk_render_node_unref); |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gdk_surface_queue_expose (gtk_widget_get_surface (widget)); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget); |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_queue_allocate: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function is only for use in widget implementations. |
| * |
| * Flags the widget for a rerun of the GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate |
| * function. Use this function instead of gtk_widget_queue_resize() |
| * when the @widget's size request didn't change but it wants to |
| * reposition its contents. |
| * |
| * An example user of this function is gtk_widget_set_halign(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_queue_allocate (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static inline gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->resize_needed; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Queue a resize on a widget, and on all other widgets grouped with this widget. |
| */ |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *groups, *l, *widgets; |
| |
| if (gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (widget)) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->resize_needed = TRUE; |
| gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (widget); |
| |
| groups = _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (widget); |
| |
| for (l = groups; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| for (widgets = gtk_size_group_get_widgets (l->data); widgets; widgets = widgets->next) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (widgets->data); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); |
| if (parent) |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (parent); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_queue_resize: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function is only for use in widget implementations. |
| * Flags a widget to have its size renegotiated; should |
| * be called when a widget for some reason has a new size request. |
| * For example, when you change the text in a #GtkLabel, #GtkLabel |
| * queues a resize to ensure there’s enough space for the new text. |
| * |
| * Note that you cannot call gtk_widget_queue_resize() on a widget |
| * from inside its implementation of the GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate |
| * virtual method. Calls to gtk_widget_queue_resize() from inside |
| * GtkWidgetClass::size_allocate will be silently ignored. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function works like gtk_widget_queue_resize(), |
| * except that the widget is not invalidated. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_no_redraw (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize_internal (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_frame_clock: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Obtains the frame clock for a widget. The frame clock is a global |
| * “ticker” that can be used to drive animations and repaints. The |
| * most common reason to get the frame clock is to call |
| * gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time(), in order to get a time to use for |
| * animating. For example you might record the start of the animation |
| * with an initial value from gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time(), and |
| * then update the animation by calling |
| * gdk_frame_clock_get_frame_time() again during each repaint. |
| * |
| * gdk_frame_clock_request_phase() will result in a new frame on the |
| * clock, but won’t necessarily repaint any widgets. To repaint a |
| * widget, you have to use gtk_widget_queue_draw() which invalidates |
| * the widget (thus scheduling it to receive a draw on the next |
| * frame). gtk_widget_queue_draw() will also end up requesting a frame |
| * on the appropriate frame clock. |
| * |
| * A widget’s frame clock will not change while the widget is |
| * mapped. Reparenting a widget (which implies a temporary unmap) can |
| * change the widget’s frame clock. |
| * |
| * Unrealized widgets do not have a frame clock. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): a #GdkFrameClock, |
| * or %NULL if widget is unrealized |
| */ |
| GdkFrameClock* |
| gtk_widget_get_frame_clock (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (priv->realized) |
| { |
| /* We use gtk_widget_get_toplevel() here to make it explicit that |
| * the frame clock is a property of the toplevel that a widget |
| * is anchored to; gdk_surface_get_toplevel() will go up the |
| * hierarchy anyways, but should squash any funny business with |
| * reparenting windows and widgets. |
| */ |
| GtkWidget *toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| GdkSurface *surface = _gtk_widget_get_surface (toplevel); |
| g_assert (surface != NULL); |
| |
| return gdk_surface_get_frame_clock (surface); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static gint |
| get_number (GtkCssStyle *style, |
| guint property) |
| { |
| double d = _gtk_css_number_value_get (gtk_css_style_get_value (style, property), 100); |
| |
| if (d < 1) |
| return ceil (d); |
| else |
| return floor (d); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| get_box_margin (GtkCssStyle *style, |
| GtkBorder *margin) |
| { |
| margin->top = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_TOP); |
| margin->left = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_LEFT); |
| margin->bottom = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_BOTTOM); |
| margin->right = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_MARGIN_RIGHT); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| get_box_border (GtkCssStyle *style, |
| GtkBorder *border) |
| { |
| border->top = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_TOP_WIDTH); |
| border->left = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_LEFT_WIDTH); |
| border->bottom = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_BOTTOM_WIDTH); |
| border->right = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_BORDER_RIGHT_WIDTH); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| get_box_padding (GtkCssStyle *style, |
| GtkBorder *border) |
| { |
| border->top = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_TOP); |
| border->left = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_LEFT); |
| border->bottom = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_BOTTOM); |
| border->right = get_number (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_PADDING_RIGHT); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_size_allocate: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @allocation: position and size to be allocated to @widget |
| * @baseline: The baseline of the child, or -1 |
| * |
| * This is a simple form of gtk_widget_allocate() that takes the new position |
| * of @widget as part of @allocation. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GtkAllocation *allocation, |
| int baseline) |
| { |
| GskTransform *transform; |
| |
| if (allocation->x || allocation->y) |
| transform = gsk_transform_translate (NULL, &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (allocation->x, allocation->y)); |
| else |
| transform = NULL; |
| |
| gtk_widget_allocate (widget, |
| allocation->width, |
| allocation->height, |
| baseline, |
| transform); |
| |
| gsk_transform_unref (transform); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_allocate: |
| * @widget: A #GtkWidget |
| * @width: New width of @widget |
| * @height: New height of @widget |
| * @baseline: New baseline of @widget, or -1 |
| * @transform: (transfer none) (allow-none): Transformation to be applied to @widget |
| * |
| * This function is only used by #GtkWidget subclasses, to assign a size, |
| * position and (optionally) baseline to their child widgets. |
| * |
| * In this function, the allocation and baseline may be adjusted. The given |
| * allocation will be forced to be bigger than the widget's minimum size, |
| * as well as at least 0×0 in size. |
| * |
| * For a version that does not take a transform, see gtk_widget_size_allocate() |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| int width, |
| int height, |
| int baseline, |
| GskTransform *transform) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GdkRectangle adjusted; |
| gboolean alloc_needed; |
| gboolean size_changed; |
| gboolean baseline_changed; |
| gboolean transform_changed; |
| gint natural_width, natural_height, dummy = 0; |
| gint min_width, min_height; |
| GtkCssStyle *style; |
| GtkBorder margin, border, padding; |
| GskTransform *css_transform; |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG |
| GdkDisplay *display; |
| #endif |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (baseline >= -1); |
| |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| if (!priv->visible && !_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| goto out; |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG |
| display = _gtk_widget_get_display (widget); |
| if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, RESIZE)) |
| { |
| priv->highlight_resize = TRUE; |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| } |
| |
| if (gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (widget)) |
| { |
| g_warning ("Allocating size to %s %p without calling gtk_widget_measure(). " |
| "How does the code know the size to allocate?", |
| gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); |
| } |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_DEBUG */ |
| |
| alloc_needed = priv->alloc_needed; |
| /* Preserve request/allocate ordering */ |
| priv->alloc_needed = FALSE; |
| |
| baseline_changed = priv->allocated_size_baseline != baseline; |
| size_changed = (priv->allocated_width != width || |
| priv->allocated_height != height); |
| transform_changed = !gsk_transform_equal (priv->allocated_transform, transform); |
| |
| /* order is important, sometimes priv->allocated_transform == transform */ |
| gsk_transform_ref (transform); |
| gsk_transform_unref (priv->allocated_transform); |
| priv->allocated_transform = transform; |
| priv->allocated_width = width; |
| priv->allocated_height = height; |
| priv->allocated_size_baseline = baseline; |
| |
| adjusted = (GdkRectangle) { 0, 0, width, height }; |
| if (gtk_widget_get_request_mode (widget) == GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_HEIGHT_FOR_WIDTH) |
| { |
| /* Go ahead and request the height for allocated width, note that the internals |
| * of get_height_for_width will internally limit the for_size to natural size |
| * when aligning implicitly. |
| */ |
| gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, -1, |
| &min_width, &natural_width, NULL, NULL); |
| gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, width, |
| &min_height, &natural_height, NULL, NULL); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Go ahead and request the width for allocated height, note that the internals |
| * of get_width_for_height will internally limit the for_size to natural size |
| * when aligning implicitly. |
| */ |
| gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, -1, |
| &min_height, &natural_height, NULL, NULL); |
| gtk_widget_measure (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, height, |
| &min_width, &natural_width, NULL, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS |
| if ((min_width > width || min_height > height) && |
| !GTK_IS_SCROLLABLE (widget)) |
| g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to underallocate %s%s %s %p. " |
| "Allocation is %dx%d, but minimum required size is %dx%d.", |
| priv->parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (priv->parent) : "", priv->parent ? "'s child" : "toplevel", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, |
| width, height, |
| min_width, min_height); |
| #endif |
| /* Now that we have the right natural height and width, go ahead and remove any margins from the |
| * allocated sizes and possibly limit them to the natural sizes */ |
| gtk_widget_adjust_size_allocation (widget, |
| GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, |
| &dummy, |
| &natural_width, |
| &adjusted.x, |
| &adjusted.width); |
| gtk_widget_adjust_size_allocation (widget, |
| GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, |
| &dummy, |
| &natural_height, |
| &adjusted.y, |
| &adjusted.height); |
| if (baseline >= 0) |
| baseline -= priv->margin.top; |
| |
| if (adjusted.width < 0 || adjusted.height < 0) |
| { |
| g_warning ("gtk_widget_size_allocate(): attempt to allocate %s %s %p with width %d and height %d", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), gtk_css_node_get_name (priv->cssnode), widget, |
| adjusted.width, |
| adjusted.height); |
| |
| adjusted.width = 0; |
| adjusted.height = 0; |
| } |
| |
| if (G_UNLIKELY (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget))) |
| { |
| adjusted.width = MAX (1, adjusted.width); |
| adjusted.height = MAX (1, adjusted.height); |
| } |
| |
| style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); |
| |
| /* Apply CSS transformation */ |
| css_transform = gtk_css_transform_value_get_transform (gtk_css_style_get_value (style, GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_TRANSFORM)); |
| |
| if (css_transform) |
| { |
| transform = gsk_transform_translate (transform, &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (adjusted.x, adjusted.y)); |
| adjusted.x = adjusted.y = 0; |
| |
| transform = gsk_transform_translate (transform, &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (adjusted.width / 2, adjusted.height / 2)); |
| transform = gsk_transform_transform (transform, css_transform); |
| transform = gsk_transform_translate (transform, &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (- adjusted.width / 2, - adjusted.height / 2)); |
| } |
| |
| get_box_margin (style, &margin); |
| get_box_border (style, &border); |
| get_box_padding (style, &padding); |
| adjusted.x += margin.left + border.left + padding.left; |
| adjusted.y += margin.top + border.top + padding.top; |
| |
| /* Since gtk_widget_measure does it for us, we can be sure here that |
| * the given alloaction is large enough for the css margin/bordder/padding */ |
| adjusted.width -= margin.left + border.left + padding.left + |
| margin.right + border.right + padding.right; |
| adjusted.height -= margin.top + border.top + padding.top + |
| margin.bottom + border.bottom + padding.bottom; |
| if (baseline >= 0) |
| baseline -= margin.top + border.top + padding.top; |
| if (adjusted.x || adjusted.y) |
| transform = gsk_transform_translate (transform, &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (adjusted.x, adjusted.y)); |
| |
| priv->transform = transform; |
| |
| if (priv->surface_transform_data) |
| sync_widget_surface_transform (widget); |
| |
| if (!alloc_needed && !size_changed && !baseline_changed) |
| { |
| /* Still have to move the window... */ |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkAllocation window_alloc; |
| |
| gtk_widget_get_surface_allocation (widget, &window_alloc); |
| gdk_surface_move_resize (priv->surface, |
| window_alloc.x, window_alloc.y, |
| window_alloc.width, window_alloc.height); |
| } |
| |
| goto skip_allocate; |
| } |
| |
| priv->width = adjusted.width; |
| priv->height = adjusted.height; |
| priv->baseline = baseline; |
| |
| if (priv->layout_manager != NULL) |
| { |
| gtk_layout_manager_allocate (priv->layout_manager, widget, |
| priv->width, |
| priv->height, |
| baseline); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (g_signal_has_handler_pending (widget, widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE], 0, FALSE)) |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[SIZE_ALLOCATE], 0, |
| priv->width, |
| priv->height, |
| baseline); |
| else |
| GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->size_allocate (widget, |
| priv->width, |
| priv->height, |
| baseline); |
| } |
| |
| /* Size allocation is god... after consulting god, no further requests or allocations are needed */ |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG |
| if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, GEOMETRY) && gtk_widget_get_resize_needed (widget)) |
| { |
| g_warning ("%s %p or a child called gtk_widget_queue_resize() during size_allocate().", |
| gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); |
| } |
| #endif |
| |
| gtk_widget_ensure_resize (widget); |
| priv->alloc_needed = FALSE; |
| priv->alloc_needed_on_child = FALSE; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_paintables (widget); |
| |
| skip_allocate: |
| if (size_changed || baseline_changed) |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| else if (transform_changed && priv->parent) |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (priv->parent); |
| |
| out: |
| if (priv->alloc_needed_on_child) |
| gtk_widget_ensure_allocate (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_common_ancestor: |
| * @widget_a: a #GtkWidget |
| * @widget_b: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Find the common ancestor of @widget_a and @widget_b that |
| * is closest to the two widgets. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable): the closest common ancestor of @widget_a and |
| * @widget_b or %NULL if @widget_a and @widget_b do not |
| * share a common ancestor. |
| **/ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_common_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget_a, |
| GtkWidget *widget_b) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent_a; |
| GtkWidget *parent_b; |
| gint depth_a = 0; |
| gint depth_b = 0; |
| |
| parent_a = widget_a; |
| while (parent_a->priv->parent) |
| { |
| parent_a = parent_a->priv->parent; |
| depth_a++; |
| } |
| |
| parent_b = widget_b; |
| while (parent_b->priv->parent) |
| { |
| parent_b = parent_b->priv->parent; |
| depth_b++; |
| } |
| |
| if (parent_a != parent_b) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| while (depth_a > depth_b) |
| { |
| widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent; |
| depth_a--; |
| } |
| |
| while (depth_b > depth_a) |
| { |
| widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent; |
| depth_b--; |
| } |
| |
| while (widget_a != widget_b) |
| { |
| widget_a = widget_a->priv->parent; |
| widget_b = widget_b->priv->parent; |
| } |
| |
| return widget_a; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_translate_coordinates: |
| * @src_widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @dest_widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @src_x: X position relative to @src_widget |
| * @src_y: Y position relative to @src_widget |
| * @dest_x: (out) (optional): location to store X position relative to @dest_widget |
| * @dest_y: (out) (optional): location to store Y position relative to @dest_widget |
| * |
| * Translate coordinates relative to @src_widget’s allocation to coordinates |
| * relative to @dest_widget’s allocations. In order to perform this |
| * operation, both widget must share a common toplevel. |
| * |
| * Returns: %FALSE if @src_widget and @dest_widget have no common |
| * ancestor. In this case, 0 is stored in |
| * *@dest_x and *@dest_y. Otherwise %TRUE. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_translate_coordinates (GtkWidget *src_widget, |
| GtkWidget *dest_widget, |
| gint src_x, |
| gint src_y, |
| gint *dest_x, |
| gint *dest_y) |
| { |
| graphene_point_t p; |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_compute_point (src_widget, dest_widget, |
| &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (src_x, src_y), |
| &p)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| if (dest_x) |
| *dest_x = p.x; |
| |
| if (dest_y) |
| *dest_y = p.y; |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_compute_point: |
| * @widget: the #GtkWidget to query |
| * @target: the #GtkWidget to transform into |
| * @point: a point in @widget's coordinate system |
| * @out_point: (out caller-allocates): Set to the corresponding coordinates in |
| * @target's coordinate system |
| * |
| * Translates the given @point in @widget's coordinates to coordinates |
| * relative to @target’s coodinate system. In order to perform this |
| * operation, both widgets must share a common ancestor. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the point could be determined, %FALSE on failure. |
| * In this case, 0 is stored in @out_point. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_compute_point (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *target, |
| const graphene_point_t *point, |
| graphene_point_t *out_point) |
| { |
| graphene_matrix_t transform; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (target), FALSE); |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_compute_transform (widget, target, &transform)) |
| { |
| graphene_point_init (out_point, 0, 0); |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| graphene_matrix_transform_point (&transform, point, out_point); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_size_allocate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| int width, |
| int height, |
| int baseline) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkAllocation window_alloc; |
| |
| gtk_widget_get_surface_allocation (widget, &window_alloc); |
| gdk_surface_move_resize (priv->surface, |
| window_alloc.x, window_alloc.y, |
| window_alloc.width, window_alloc.height); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* translate initial/final into start/end */ |
| static GtkAlign |
| effective_align (GtkAlign align, |
| GtkTextDirection direction) |
| { |
| switch (align) |
| { |
| case GTK_ALIGN_START: |
| return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_END : GTK_ALIGN_START; |
| case GTK_ALIGN_END: |
| return direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL ? GTK_ALIGN_START : GTK_ALIGN_END; |
| case GTK_ALIGN_FILL: |
| case GTK_ALIGN_CENTER: |
| case GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE: |
| default: |
| return align; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| adjust_for_align (GtkAlign align, |
| gint *natural_size, |
| gint *allocated_pos, |
| gint *allocated_size) |
| { |
| switch (align) |
| { |
| case GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE: |
| case GTK_ALIGN_FILL: |
| default: |
| /* change nothing */ |
| break; |
| case GTK_ALIGN_START: |
| /* keep *allocated_pos where it is */ |
| *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size); |
| break; |
| case GTK_ALIGN_END: |
| if (*allocated_size > *natural_size) |
| { |
| *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size); |
| *allocated_size = *natural_size; |
| } |
| break; |
| case GTK_ALIGN_CENTER: |
| if (*allocated_size > *natural_size) |
| { |
| *allocated_pos += (*allocated_size - *natural_size) / 2; |
| *allocated_size = MIN (*allocated_size, *natural_size); |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| adjust_for_margin(gint start_margin, |
| gint end_margin, |
| gint *minimum_size, |
| gint *natural_size, |
| gint *allocated_pos, |
| gint *allocated_size) |
| { |
| *minimum_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); |
| *natural_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); |
| *allocated_pos += start_margin; |
| *allocated_size -= (start_margin + end_margin); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_adjust_size_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation, |
| gint *minimum_size, |
| gint *natural_size, |
| gint *allocated_pos, |
| gint *allocated_size) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) |
| { |
| adjust_for_margin (priv->margin.left, |
| priv->margin.right, |
| minimum_size, natural_size, |
| allocated_pos, allocated_size); |
| adjust_for_align (effective_align (priv->halign, _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)), |
| natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| adjust_for_margin (priv->margin.top, |
| priv->margin.bottom, |
| minimum_size, natural_size, |
| allocated_pos, allocated_size); |
| adjust_for_align (effective_align (priv->valign, GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE), |
| natural_size, allocated_pos, allocated_size); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_real_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, |
| guint signal_id) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| /* widgets must be onscreen for accels to take effect */ |
| return gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && |
| _gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget) && |
| gdk_surface_is_viewable (priv->surface); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_can_activate_accel: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @signal_id: the ID of a signal installed on @widget |
| * |
| * Determines whether an accelerator that activates the signal |
| * identified by @signal_id can currently be activated. |
| * This is done by emitting the #GtkWidget::can-activate-accel |
| * signal on @widget; if the signal isn’t overridden by a |
| * handler or in a derived widget, then the default check is |
| * that the widget must be sensitive, and the widget and all |
| * its ancestors mapped. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the accelerator can be activated. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (GtkWidget *widget, |
| guint signal_id) |
| { |
| gboolean can_activate = FALSE; |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[CAN_ACTIVATE_ACCEL], 0, signal_id, &can_activate); |
| return can_activate; |
| } |
| |
| typedef struct { |
| GClosure closure; |
| guint signal_id; |
| } AccelClosure; |
| |
| static void |
| closure_accel_activate (GClosure *closure, |
| GValue *return_value, |
| guint n_param_values, |
| const GValue *param_values, |
| gpointer invocation_hint, |
| gpointer marshal_data) |
| { |
| AccelClosure *aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure; |
| gboolean can_activate = gtk_widget_can_activate_accel (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id); |
| |
| if (can_activate) |
| g_signal_emit (closure->data, aclosure->signal_id, 0); |
| |
| /* whether accelerator was handled */ |
| g_value_set_boolean (return_value, can_activate); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| closures_destroy (gpointer data) |
| { |
| GSList *slist, *closures = data; |
| |
| for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next) |
| { |
| g_closure_invalidate (slist->data); |
| g_closure_unref (slist->data); |
| } |
| g_slist_free (closures); |
| } |
| |
| static GClosure* |
| widget_new_accel_closure (GtkWidget *widget, |
| guint signal_id) |
| { |
| AccelClosure *aclosure; |
| GClosure *closure = NULL; |
| GSList *slist, *closures; |
| |
| closures = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); |
| for (slist = closures; slist; slist = slist->next) |
| if (!gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data)) |
| { |
| /* reuse this closure */ |
| closure = slist->data; |
| break; |
| } |
| if (!closure) |
| { |
| closure = g_closure_new_object (sizeof (AccelClosure), G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| closures = g_slist_prepend (closures, g_closure_ref (closure)); |
| g_closure_sink (closure); |
| g_closure_set_marshal (closure, closure_accel_activate); |
| } |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, closures, closures_destroy); |
| |
| aclosure = (AccelClosure*) closure; |
| g_assert (closure->data == widget); |
| g_assert (closure->marshal == closure_accel_activate); |
| aclosure->signal_id = signal_id; |
| |
| return closure; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_add_accelerator: |
| * @widget: widget to install an accelerator on |
| * @accel_signal: widget signal to emit on accelerator activation |
| * @accel_group: accel group for this widget, added to its toplevel |
| * @accel_key: GDK keyval of the accelerator |
| * @accel_mods: modifier key combination of the accelerator |
| * @accel_flags: flag accelerators, e.g. %GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE |
| * |
| * Installs an accelerator for this @widget in @accel_group that causes |
| * @accel_signal to be emitted if the accelerator is activated. |
| * The @accel_group needs to be added to the widget’s toplevel via |
| * gtk_window_add_accel_group(), and the signal must be of type %G_SIGNAL_ACTION. |
| * Accelerators added through this function are not user changeable during |
| * runtime. If you want to support accelerators that can be changed by the |
| * user, use gtk_accel_map_add_entry() and gtk_widget_set_accel_path() or |
| * gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() instead. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *accel_signal, |
| GtkAccelGroup *accel_group, |
| guint accel_key, |
| GdkModifierType accel_mods, |
| GtkAccelFlags accel_flags) |
| { |
| GClosure *closure; |
| GSignalQuery query; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (accel_signal != NULL); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group)); |
| |
| g_signal_query (g_signal_lookup (accel_signal, G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget)), &query); |
| if (!query.signal_id || |
| !(query.signal_flags & G_SIGNAL_ACTION) || |
| query.return_type != G_TYPE_NONE || |
| query.n_params) |
| { |
| /* hmm, should be elaborate enough */ |
| g_warning (G_STRLOC ": widget '%s' has no activatable signal \"%s\" without arguments", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), accel_signal); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, query.signal_id); |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| |
| /* install the accelerator. since we don't map this onto an accel_path, |
| * the accelerator will automatically be locked. |
| */ |
| gtk_accel_group_connect (accel_group, |
| accel_key, |
| accel_mods, |
| accel_flags | GTK_ACCEL_LOCKED, |
| closure); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); |
| |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_remove_accelerator: |
| * @widget: widget to install an accelerator on |
| * @accel_group: accel group for this widget |
| * @accel_key: GDK keyval of the accelerator |
| * @accel_mods: modifier key combination of the accelerator |
| * |
| * Removes an accelerator from @widget, previously installed with |
| * gtk_widget_add_accelerator(). |
| * |
| * Returns: whether an accelerator was installed and could be removed |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_remove_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkAccelGroup *accel_group, |
| guint accel_key, |
| GdkModifierType accel_mods) |
| { |
| GtkAccelGroupEntry *ag_entry; |
| GList *slist, *clist; |
| guint n; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group), FALSE); |
| |
| ag_entry = gtk_accel_group_query (accel_group, accel_key, accel_mods, &n); |
| clist = gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (widget); |
| for (slist = clist; slist; slist = slist->next) |
| { |
| guint i; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < n; i++) |
| if (slist->data == (gpointer) ag_entry[i].closure) |
| { |
| gboolean is_removed = gtk_accel_group_disconnect (accel_group, slist->data); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); |
| |
| g_list_free (clist); |
| |
| return is_removed; |
| } |
| } |
| g_list_free (clist); |
| |
| g_warning (G_STRLOC ": no accelerator (%u,%u) installed in accel group (%p) for %s (%p)", |
| accel_key, accel_mods, accel_group, |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_list_accel_closures: |
| * @widget: widget to list accelerator closures for |
| * |
| * Lists the closures used by @widget for accelerator group connections |
| * with gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path() or gtk_accel_group_connect(). |
| * The closures can be used to monitor accelerator changes on @widget, |
| * by connecting to the @GtkAccelGroup::accel-changed signal of the |
| * #GtkAccelGroup of a closure which can be found out with |
| * gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure(). |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer container) (element-type GClosure): |
| * a newly allocated #GList of closures |
| */ |
| GList* |
| gtk_widget_list_accel_closures (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GSList *slist; |
| GList *clist = NULL; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| for (slist = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures); slist; slist = slist->next) |
| if (gtk_accel_group_from_accel_closure (slist->data)) |
| clist = g_list_prepend (clist, slist->data); |
| return clist; |
| } |
| |
| typedef struct { |
| GQuark path_quark; |
| GtkAccelGroup *accel_group; |
| GClosure *closure; |
| } AccelPath; |
| |
| static void |
| destroy_accel_path (gpointer data) |
| { |
| AccelPath *apath = data; |
| |
| gtk_accel_group_disconnect (apath->accel_group, apath->closure); |
| |
| /* closures_destroy takes care of unrefing the closure */ |
| g_object_unref (apath->accel_group); |
| |
| g_slice_free (AccelPath, apath); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_accel_path: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @accel_path: (allow-none): path used to look up the accelerator |
| * @accel_group: (allow-none): a #GtkAccelGroup. |
| * |
| * Given an accelerator group, @accel_group, and an accelerator path, |
| * @accel_path, sets up an accelerator in @accel_group so whenever the |
| * key binding that is defined for @accel_path is pressed, @widget |
| * will be activated. This removes any accelerators (for any |
| * accelerator group) installed by previous calls to |
| * gtk_widget_set_accel_path(). Associating accelerators with |
| * paths allows them to be modified by the user and the modifications |
| * to be saved for future use. (See gtk_accel_map_save().) |
| * |
| * This function is a low level function that would most likely |
| * be used by a menu creation system. |
| * |
| * If you only want to |
| * set up accelerators on menu items gtk_menu_item_set_accel_path() |
| * provides a somewhat more convenient interface. |
| * |
| * Note that @accel_path string will be stored in a #GQuark. Therefore, if you |
| * pass a static string, you can save some memory by interning it first with |
| * g_intern_static_string(). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *accel_path, |
| GtkAccelGroup *accel_group) |
| { |
| AccelPath *apath; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal != 0); |
| |
| if (accel_path) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_ACCEL_GROUP (accel_group)); |
| g_return_if_fail (_gtk_accel_path_is_valid (accel_path)); |
| |
| gtk_accel_map_add_entry (accel_path, 0, 0); |
| apath = g_slice_new (AccelPath); |
| apath->accel_group = g_object_ref (accel_group); |
| apath->path_quark = g_quark_from_string (accel_path); |
| apath->closure = widget_new_accel_closure (widget, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal); |
| } |
| else |
| apath = NULL; |
| |
| /* also removes possible old settings */ |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, apath, destroy_accel_path); |
| |
| if (apath) |
| gtk_accel_group_connect_by_path (apath->accel_group, g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark), apath->closure); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[ACCEL_CLOSURES_CHANGED], 0); |
| } |
| |
| const gchar* |
| _gtk_widget_get_accel_path (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean *locked) |
| { |
| AccelPath *apath; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| apath = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path); |
| if (locked) |
| *locked = apath ? gtk_accel_group_get_is_locked (apath->accel_group) : TRUE; |
| return apath ? g_quark_to_string (apath->path_quark) : NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @group_cycling: %TRUE if there are other widgets with the same mnemonic |
| * |
| * Emits the #GtkWidget::mnemonic-activate signal. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the signal has been handled |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean group_cycling) |
| { |
| gboolean handled; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| group_cycling = group_cycling != FALSE; |
| if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) |
| handled = TRUE; |
| else |
| g_signal_emit (widget, |
| widget_signals[MNEMONIC_ACTIVATE], |
| 0, |
| group_cycling, |
| &handled); |
| return handled; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_real_mnemonic_activate (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean group_cycling) |
| { |
| if (!group_cycling && GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal) |
| gtk_widget_activate (widget); |
| else if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); |
| else |
| { |
| g_warning ("widget '%s' isn't suitable for mnemonic activation", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); |
| gtk_widget_error_bell (widget); |
| } |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| #define WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT(widget, event) \ |
| (event->any.type == GDK_FOCUS_CHANGE || _gtk_widget_get_realized(widget)) |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_event: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @event: a #GdkEvent |
| * |
| * Rarely-used function. This function is used to emit |
| * the event signals on a widget (those signals should never |
| * be emitted without using this function to do so). |
| * If you want to synthesize an event though, don’t use this function; |
| * instead, use gtk_main_do_event() so the event will behave as if |
| * it were in the event queue. |
| * |
| * Returns: return from the event signal emission (%TRUE if |
| * the event was handled) |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_event (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GdkEvent *event) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event), TRUE); |
| |
| return gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_set_captured_event_handler (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkCapturedEventHandler callback) |
| { |
| g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), I_("captured-event-handler"), callback); |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_run_controllers (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GdkEvent *event, |
| GtkPropagationPhase phase) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkEventController *controller; |
| gboolean handled = FALSE; |
| GList *l; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| |
| l = priv->event_controllers; |
| while (l != NULL) |
| { |
| GList *next = l->next; |
| |
| if (!WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event)) |
| break; |
| |
| controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (controller == NULL) |
| { |
| priv->event_controllers = g_list_delete_link (priv->event_controllers, l); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| GtkPropagationPhase controller_phase; |
| |
| controller_phase = gtk_event_controller_get_propagation_phase (controller); |
| |
| if (controller_phase == phase) |
| handled |= gtk_event_controller_handle_event (controller, event); |
| |
| /* Non-gesture controllers are basically unique entities not meant |
| * to collaborate with anything else. Break early if any such event |
| * controller handled the event. |
| */ |
| if (handled && !GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| l = next; |
| } |
| |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| |
| return handled; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| translate_event_coordinates (GdkEvent *event, |
| GtkWidget *widget); |
| gboolean |
| _gtk_widget_captured_event (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GdkEvent *event) |
| { |
| gboolean return_val = FALSE; |
| GtkCapturedEventHandler handler; |
| GdkEvent *event_copy; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), TRUE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event), TRUE); |
| |
| if (!event_surface_is_still_viewable (event)) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| event_copy = gdk_event_copy (event); |
| translate_event_coordinates (event_copy, widget); |
| |
| return_val = gtk_widget_run_controllers (widget, event_copy, GTK_PHASE_CAPTURE); |
| |
| handler = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), I_("captured-event-handler")); |
| if (!handler) |
| goto out; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| |
| return_val |= handler (widget, event_copy); |
| return_val |= !WIDGET_REALIZED_FOR_EVENT (widget, event_copy); |
| |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| |
| out: |
| g_object_unref (event_copy); |
| |
| return return_val; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| event_surface_is_still_viewable (const GdkEvent *event) |
| { |
| /* Check that we think the event's window is viewable before |
| * delivering the event, to prevent surprises. We do this here |
| * at the last moment, since the event may have been queued |
| * up behind other events, held over a recursive main loop, etc. |
| */ |
| switch ((guint) event->any.type) |
| { |
| case GDK_MOTION_NOTIFY: |
| case GDK_BUTTON_PRESS: |
| case GDK_KEY_PRESS: |
| case GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY: |
| case GDK_PROXIMITY_IN: |
| case GDK_SCROLL: |
| return event->any.surface && gdk_surface_is_viewable (event->any.surface); |
| |
| #if 0 |
| /* The following events are the second half of paired events; |
| * we always deliver them to deal with widgets that clean up |
| * on the second half. |
| */ |
| case GDK_BUTTON_RELEASE: |
| case GDK_KEY_RELEASE: |
| case GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY: |
| case GDK_PROXIMITY_OUT: |
| #endif |
| |
| default: |
| /* Remaining events would make sense on an not-viewable window, |
| * or don't have an associated window. |
| */ |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| translate_event_coordinates (GdkEvent *event, |
| GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *event_widget; |
| double x, y; |
| graphene_point_t p; |
| |
| if (!gdk_event_get_coords (event, &x, &y)) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| event_widget = gtk_get_event_widget (event); |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_compute_point (event_widget, |
| widget, |
| &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (x, y), |
| &p)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| gdk_event_set_coords (event, p.x, p.y); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_event_internal (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GdkEvent *event) |
| { |
| gboolean return_val = FALSE; |
| GdkEvent *event_copy; |
| |
| /* We check only once for is-still-visible; if someone |
| * hides the window in on of the signals on the widget, |
| * they are responsible for returning TRUE to terminate |
| * handling. |
| */ |
| if (!event_surface_is_still_viewable (event)) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| event_copy = gdk_event_copy (event); |
| |
| translate_event_coordinates (event_copy, widget); |
| |
| if (widget == gtk_get_event_target (event_copy)) |
| return_val |= gtk_widget_run_controllers (widget, event_copy, GTK_PHASE_TARGET); |
| |
| if (return_val == FALSE) |
| return_val |= gtk_widget_run_controllers (widget, event_copy, GTK_PHASE_BUBBLE); |
| g_object_unref (event_copy); |
| |
| if (return_val == FALSE && |
| (event->any.type == GDK_KEY_PRESS || |
| event->any.type == GDK_KEY_RELEASE)) |
| return_val |= gtk_bindings_activate_event (G_OBJECT (widget), (GdkEventKey *) event); |
| |
| return return_val; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_activate: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget that’s activatable |
| * |
| * For widgets that can be “activated” (buttons, menu items, etc.) |
| * this function activates them. Activation is what happens when you |
| * press Enter on a widget during key navigation. If @widget isn't |
| * activatable, the function returns %FALSE. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget was activatable |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_activate (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| if (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal) |
| { |
| /* FIXME: we should eventually check the signals signature here */ |
| g_signal_emit (widget, GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->activate_signal, 0); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * _gtk_widget_grab_notify: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @was_grabbed: whether a grab is now in effect |
| * |
| * Emits the #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal on @widget. |
| **/ |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_grab_notify (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean was_grabbed) |
| { |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[GRAB_NOTIFY], 0, was_grabbed); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_grab_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Causes @widget (or one of its descendents) to have the keyboard focus |
| * for the #GtkWindow it's inside. |
| * |
| * @widget must be focusable, or have a ::grab_focus implementation that |
| * transfers the focus to a descendant of @widget that is focusable. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_grab_focus (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->grab_focus (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_grab_focus (GtkWidget *focus_widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (focus_widget); |
| if (priv->root) |
| gtk_root_set_focus (priv->root, focus_widget); |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_real_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint x, |
| gint y, |
| gboolean keyboard_tip, |
| GtkTooltip *tooltip) |
| { |
| gchar *tooltip_markup; |
| gboolean has_tooltip; |
| |
| tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup); |
| has_tooltip = gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (widget); |
| |
| if (has_tooltip && tooltip_markup) |
| { |
| gtk_tooltip_set_markup (tooltip, tooltip_markup); |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_query_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint x, |
| gint y, |
| gboolean keyboard_mode, |
| GtkTooltip *tooltip) |
| { |
| gboolean retval = FALSE; |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, |
| widget_signals[QUERY_TOOLTIP], |
| 0, |
| x, y, |
| keyboard_mode, |
| tooltip, |
| &retval); |
| |
| return retval; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_state_flags_changed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkStateFlags old_state) |
| { |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_style_updated (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkCssStyleChange *change = NULL; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_alpha (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| change = gtk_style_context_get_change (priv->context); |
| |
| if (change) |
| { |
| const gboolean has_text = gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (widget) != NULL; |
| |
| if (has_text && gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TEXT)) |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->root) |
| { |
| if (gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_SIZE) || |
| (has_text && gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TEXT_SIZE))) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| } |
| else if (gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TRANSFORM)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); |
| } |
| else if (gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_REDRAW) || |
| (has_text && gtk_css_style_change_affects (change, GTK_CSS_AFFECTS_TEXT_CONTENT))) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->root) |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_real_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction) |
| { |
| if (gtk_widget_get_can_focus (widget)) |
| { |
| if (!gtk_widget_is_focus (widget)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_grab_focus (widget); |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| } |
| else if (_gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget) == NULL) |
| { |
| /* No children, no possibility to focus anything */ |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Try focusing any of the child widgets, depending on the given direction */ |
| if (gtk_widget_focus_move (widget, direction)) |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_move_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| |
| if (widget != toplevel && GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) |
| g_signal_emit (toplevel, widget_signals[MOVE_FOCUS], 0, direction); |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_real_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction) |
| { |
| switch (direction) |
| { |
| case GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD: |
| case GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD: |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| case GTK_DIR_UP: |
| case GTK_DIR_DOWN: |
| case GTK_DIR_LEFT: |
| case GTK_DIR_RIGHT: |
| default: |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_error_bell (widget); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_can_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @can_focus: whether or not @widget can own the input focus. |
| * |
| * Specifies whether @widget can own the input focus. |
| * |
| * Note that having @can_focus be %TRUE is only one of the |
| * necessary conditions for being focusable. A widget must |
| * also be sensitive and not have a ancestor that is marked |
| * as not child-focusable in order to receive input focus. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_grab_focus() for actually setting the input |
| * focus on a widget. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean can_focus) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->can_focus != can_focus) |
| { |
| priv->can_focus = can_focus; |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_CAN_FOCUS]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_can_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget can own the input focus. See |
| * gtk_widget_set_can_focus(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget can own the input focus, %FALSE otherwise |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_can_focus (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->can_focus; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_has_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines if the widget has the global input focus. See |
| * gtk_widget_is_focus() for the difference between having the global |
| * input focus, and only having the focus within a toplevel. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget has the global input focus. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->has_focus; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_has_visible_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines if the widget should show a visible indication that |
| * it has the global input focus. This is a convenience function for |
| * use in ::draw handlers that takes into account whether focus |
| * indication should currently be shown in the toplevel window of |
| * @widget. See gtk_window_get_focus_visible() for more information |
| * about focus indication. |
| * |
| * To find out if the widget has the global input focus, use |
| * gtk_widget_has_focus(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget should display a “focus rectangle” |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_has_visible_focus (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gboolean draw_focus; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| if (priv->has_focus) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| |
| toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) |
| draw_focus = gtk_window_get_focus_visible (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); |
| else |
| draw_focus = TRUE; |
| } |
| else |
| draw_focus = FALSE; |
| |
| return draw_focus; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_is_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines if the widget is the focus widget within its |
| * toplevel. (This does not mean that the #GtkWidget:has-focus property is |
| * necessarily set; #GtkWidget:has-focus will only be set if the |
| * toplevel widget additionally has the global input focus.) |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is the focus widget. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_is_focus (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| if (priv->root) |
| return widget == gtk_root_get_focus (priv->root); |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @focus_on_click: whether the widget should grab focus when clicked with the mouse |
| * |
| * Sets whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse. |
| * Making mouse clicks not grab focus is useful in places like toolbars where |
| * you don’t want the keyboard focus removed from the main area of the |
| * application. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean focus_on_click) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| focus_on_click = focus_on_click != FALSE; |
| |
| if (priv->focus_on_click != focus_on_click) |
| { |
| priv->focus_on_click = focus_on_click; |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_FOCUS_ON_CLICK]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_focus_on_click: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns whether the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with the mouse. |
| * See gtk_widget_set_focus_on_click(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget should grab focus when it is clicked with |
| * the mouse. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_focus_on_click (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->focus_on_click; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_has_default: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget is the current default widget within its |
| * toplevel. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is the current default widget within |
| * its toplevel, %FALSE otherwise |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_has_default (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->has_default; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_set_has_default (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean has_default) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkStyleContext *context; |
| |
| priv->has_default = has_default; |
| |
| context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); |
| |
| if (has_default) |
| gtk_style_context_add_class (context, GTK_STYLE_CLASS_DEFAULT); |
| else |
| gtk_style_context_remove_class (context, GTK_STYLE_CLASS_DEFAULT); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_receives_default: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @receives_default: whether or not @widget can be a default widget. |
| * |
| * Specifies whether @widget will be treated as the default |
| * widget within its toplevel when it has the focus, even if |
| * another widget is the default. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean receives_default) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->receives_default != receives_default) |
| { |
| priv->receives_default = receives_default; |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_RECEIVES_DEFAULT]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_receives_default: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget is always treated as the default widget |
| * within its toplevel when it has the focus, even if another widget |
| * is the default. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_set_receives_default(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget acts as the default widget when focused, |
| * %FALSE otherwise |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_receives_default (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->receives_default; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_has_grab: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether the widget is currently grabbing events, so it |
| * is the only widget receiving input events (keyboard and mouse). |
| * |
| * See also gtk_grab_add(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is in the grab_widgets stack |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->has_grab; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_set_has_grab (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean has_grab) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->has_grab = has_grab; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @device: a #GdkDevice |
| * |
| * Returns %TRUE if @device has been shadowed by a GTK+ |
| * device grab on another widget, so it would stop sending |
| * events to @widget. This may be used in the |
| * #GtkWidget::grab-notify signal to check for specific |
| * devices. See gtk_device_grab_add(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if there is an ongoing grab on @device |
| * by another #GtkWidget than @widget. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_device_is_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkDevice *device) |
| { |
| GtkWindowGroup *group; |
| GtkWidget *grab_widget, *toplevel; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), FALSE); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) |
| group = gtk_window_get_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); |
| else |
| group = gtk_window_get_group (NULL); |
| |
| grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_device_grab (group, device); |
| |
| /* Widget not inside the hierarchy of grab_widget */ |
| if (grab_widget && |
| widget != grab_widget && |
| !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget)) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| grab_widget = gtk_window_group_get_current_grab (group); |
| if (grab_widget && widget != grab_widget && |
| !gtk_widget_is_ancestor (widget, grab_widget)) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_name: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @name: name for the widget |
| * |
| * Widgets can be named, which allows you to refer to them from a |
| * CSS file. You can apply a style to widgets with a particular name |
| * in the CSS file. See the documentation for the CSS syntax (on the |
| * same page as the docs for #GtkStyleContext). |
| * |
| * Note that the CSS syntax has certain special characters to delimit |
| * and represent elements in a selector (period, #, >, *...), so using |
| * these will make your widget impossible to match by name. Any combination |
| * of alphanumeric symbols, dashes and underscores will suffice. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_name (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *name) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| g_free (priv->name); |
| priv->name = g_strdup (name); |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_id (priv->context, priv->name); |
| |
| gtk_css_node_set_id (priv->cssnode, priv->name); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_NAME]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_name: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Retrieves the name of a widget. See gtk_widget_set_name() for the |
| * significance of widget names. |
| * |
| * Returns: name of the widget. This string is owned by GTK+ and |
| * should not be modified or freed |
| **/ |
| const gchar* |
| gtk_widget_get_name (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (priv->name) |
| return priv->name; |
| return G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_update_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkStateFlags flags_to_set, |
| GtkStateFlags flags_to_unset) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| /* Handle insensitive first, since it is propagated |
| * differently throughout the widget hierarchy. |
| */ |
| if ((priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags_to_unset & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)) |
| gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, TRUE); |
| else if (!(priv->state_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) && (flags_to_set & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)) |
| gtk_widget_set_sensitive (widget, FALSE); |
| |
| flags_to_set &= ~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); |
| flags_to_unset &= ~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE); |
| |
| if (flags_to_set != 0 || flags_to_unset != 0) |
| { |
| GtkStateData data; |
| |
| data.old_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); |
| data.flags_to_set = flags_to_set; |
| data.flags_to_unset = flags_to_unset; |
| |
| gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_state_flags: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @flags: State flags to turn on |
| * @clear: Whether to clear state before turning on @flags |
| * |
| * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns on flag |
| * values in the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.). |
| * |
| * This function accepts the values %GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR and |
| * %GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL but ignores them. If you want to set the widget's |
| * direction, use gtk_widget_set_direction(). |
| * |
| * It is worth mentioning that any other state than %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE, |
| * will be propagated down to all non-internal children if @widget is a |
| * #GtkContainer, while %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE itself will be propagated |
| * down to all #GtkContainer children by different means than turning on the |
| * state flag down the hierarchy, both gtk_widget_get_state_flags() and |
| * gtk_widget_is_sensitive() will make use of these. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkStateFlags flags, |
| gboolean clear) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| #define ALLOWED_FLAGS (~(GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR | GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL)) |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if ((!clear && (priv->state_flags & flags) == flags) || |
| (clear && priv->state_flags == flags)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (clear) |
| gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags & ALLOWED_FLAGS, ~flags & ALLOWED_FLAGS); |
| else |
| gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, flags & ALLOWED_FLAGS, 0); |
| |
| #undef ALLOWED_FLAGS |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_unset_state_flags: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @flags: State flags to turn off |
| * |
| * This function is for use in widget implementations. Turns off flag |
| * values for the current widget state (insensitive, prelighted, etc.). |
| * See gtk_widget_set_state_flags(). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkStateFlags flags) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if ((priv->state_flags & flags) == 0) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, 0, flags); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_state_flags: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the widget state as a flag set. It is worth mentioning |
| * that the effective %GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE state will be |
| * returned, that is, also based on parent insensitivity, even if |
| * @widget itself is sensitive. |
| * |
| * Also note that if you are looking for a way to obtain the |
| * #GtkStateFlags to pass to a #GtkStyleContext method, you |
| * should look at gtk_style_context_get_state(). |
| * |
| * Returns: The state flags for widget |
| **/ |
| GtkStateFlags |
| gtk_widget_get_state_flags (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->state_flags; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_visible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @visible: whether the widget should be shown or not |
| * |
| * Sets the visibility state of @widget. Note that setting this to |
| * %TRUE doesn’t mean the widget is actually viewable, see |
| * gtk_widget_get_visible(). |
| * |
| * This function simply calls gtk_widget_show() or gtk_widget_hide() |
| * but is nicer to use when the visibility of the widget depends on |
| * some condition. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_visible (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean visible) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (visible) |
| gtk_widget_show (widget); |
| else |
| gtk_widget_hide (widget); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_set_visible_flag (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean visible) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->visible = visible; |
| |
| if (!visible) |
| { |
| g_clear_pointer (&priv->allocated_transform, gsk_transform_unref); |
| priv->allocated_width = 0; |
| priv->allocated_height = 0; |
| priv->allocated_size_baseline = 0; |
| g_clear_pointer (&priv->transform, gsk_transform_unref); |
| priv->width = 0; |
| priv->height = 0; |
| gtk_widget_update_paintables (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_visible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether the widget is visible. If you want to |
| * take into account whether the widget’s parent is also marked as |
| * visible, use gtk_widget_is_visible() instead. |
| * |
| * This function does not check if the widget is obscured in any way. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_set_visible(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is visible |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_visible (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->visible; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_is_visible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether the widget and all its parents are marked as |
| * visible. |
| * |
| * This function does not check if the widget is obscured in any way. |
| * |
| * See also gtk_widget_get_visible() and gtk_widget_set_visible() |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget and all its parents are visible |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_is_visible (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| while (widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!priv->visible) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| widget = priv->parent; |
| } |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_has_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @has_surface: whether or not @widget has a surface. |
| * |
| * Specifies whether @widget has a #GdkSurface of its own. Note that |
| * all realized widgets have a non-%NULL “window” pointer |
| * (gtk_widget_get_surface() never returns a %NULL surface when a widget |
| * is realized), but for many of them it’s actually the #GdkSurface of |
| * one of its parent widgets. Widgets that do not create a %window for |
| * themselves in #GtkWidget::realize must announce this by |
| * calling this function with @has_surface = %FALSE. |
| * |
| * This function should only be called by widget implementations, |
| * and they should call it in their init() function. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_has_surface (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean has_surface) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| priv->no_surface = !has_surface; |
| priv->no_surface_set = TRUE; |
| |
| /* GdkSurface has a min size of 1×1 */ |
| priv->width = 1; |
| priv->height = 1; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_has_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget has a #GdkSurface of its own. See |
| * gtk_widget_set_has_surface(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget has a surface, %FALSE otherwise |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_has_surface (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return !priv->no_surface; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_is_toplevel: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget is a toplevel widget. |
| * |
| * Currently only #GtkWindows are toplevel widgets. |
| * Toplevel widgets have no parent widget and implement |
| * the #GtkRoot interface. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is a toplevel, %FALSE otherwise |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_is_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return GTK_IS_ROOT (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_is_drawable: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget can be drawn to. A widget can be drawn |
| * if it is mapped and visible. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is drawable, %FALSE otherwise |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_is_drawable (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_realized: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget is realized. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is realized, %FALSE otherwise |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_realized (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->realized; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_mapped: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Whether the widget is mapped. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is mapped, %FALSE otherwise. |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_mapped (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->mapped; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_sensitive: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @sensitive: %TRUE to make the widget sensitive |
| * |
| * Sets the sensitivity of a widget. A widget is sensitive if the user |
| * can interact with it. Insensitive widgets are “grayed out” and the |
| * user can’t interact with them. Insensitive widgets are known as |
| * “inactive”, “disabled”, or “ghosted” in some other toolkits. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean sensitive) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| sensitive = (sensitive != FALSE); |
| |
| if (priv->sensitive == sensitive) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->sensitive = sensitive; |
| |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| |
| gtk_event_controller_reset (controller); |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->parent == NULL |
| || gtk_widget_is_sensitive (priv->parent)) |
| { |
| GtkStateData data; |
| |
| data.old_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); |
| |
| if (sensitive) |
| { |
| data.flags_to_set = 0; |
| data.flags_to_unset = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| data.flags_to_set = GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; |
| data.flags_to_unset = GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT | |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); |
| update_cursor_on_state_change (widget); |
| } |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_SENSITIVE]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_sensitive: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the widget’s sensitivity (in the sense of returning |
| * the value that has been set using gtk_widget_set_sensitive()). |
| * |
| * The effective sensitivity of a widget is however determined by both its |
| * own and its parent widget’s sensitivity. See gtk_widget_is_sensitive(). |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is sensitive |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->sensitive; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_is_sensitive: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the widget’s effective sensitivity, which means |
| * it is sensitive itself and also its parent widget is sensitive |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is effectively sensitive |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_is_sensitive (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return _gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /* Insert @widget into the children list of @parent, |
| * after @previous_sibling */ |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_reposition_after (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *parent, |
| GtkWidget *previous_sibling) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkStateFlags parent_flags; |
| GtkWidget *prev_parent, *prev_previous; |
| GtkStateData data; |
| |
| prev_parent = priv->parent; |
| prev_previous = priv->prev_sibling; |
| |
| if (priv->parent != NULL && priv->parent != parent) |
| { |
| g_warning ("Can't set new parent %s %p on widget %s %p, " |
| "which already has parent %s %p", |
| gtk_widget_get_name (parent), (void *)parent, |
| gtk_widget_get_name (widget), (void *)widget, |
| gtk_widget_get_name (priv->parent), (void *)priv->parent); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| { |
| g_warning ("Can't set a parent on a toplevel widget"); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| data.old_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); |
| |
| /* keep this function in sync with gtk_menu_attach_to_widget() |
| */ |
| |
| g_object_ref_sink (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| priv->parent = parent; |
| |
| if (previous_sibling) |
| { |
| if (previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling) |
| previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = widget; |
| |
| if (priv->prev_sibling) |
| priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = priv->next_sibling; |
| |
| if (priv->next_sibling) |
| priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; |
| |
| |
| if (parent->priv->first_child == widget) |
| parent->priv->first_child = priv->next_sibling; |
| |
| if (parent->priv->last_child == widget) |
| parent->priv->last_child = priv->prev_sibling; |
| |
| priv->prev_sibling = previous_sibling; |
| priv->next_sibling = previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling; |
| previous_sibling->priv->next_sibling = widget; |
| |
| if (parent->priv->last_child == previous_sibling) |
| parent->priv->last_child = widget; |
| else if (parent->priv->last_child == widget) |
| parent->priv->last_child = priv->next_sibling; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Beginning */ |
| if (parent->priv->last_child == widget) |
| { |
| parent->priv->last_child = priv->prev_sibling; |
| if (priv->prev_sibling) |
| priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = NULL; |
| } |
| if (priv->prev_sibling) |
| priv->prev_sibling->priv->next_sibling = priv->next_sibling; |
| |
| if (priv->next_sibling) |
| priv->next_sibling->priv->prev_sibling = priv->prev_sibling; |
| |
| priv->prev_sibling = NULL; |
| priv->next_sibling = parent->priv->first_child; |
| if (parent->priv->first_child) |
| parent->priv->first_child->priv->prev_sibling = widget; |
| |
| parent->priv->first_child = widget; |
| |
| if (parent->priv->last_child == NULL) |
| parent->priv->last_child = widget; |
| } |
| |
| parent_flags = _gtk_widget_get_state_flags (parent); |
| |
| /* Merge both old state and current parent state, |
| * making sure to only propagate the right states */ |
| data.flags_to_set = parent_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_SET_PROPAGATE; |
| data.flags_to_unset = 0; |
| gtk_widget_propagate_state (widget, &data); |
| |
| if (gtk_css_node_get_parent (priv->cssnode) == NULL) |
| { |
| gtk_css_node_insert_after (parent->priv->cssnode, |
| priv->cssnode, |
| previous_sibling ? previous_sibling->priv->cssnode : NULL); |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_parent (priv->context, |
| _gtk_widget_get_style_context (parent)); |
| |
| _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (widget); |
| |
| if (parent->priv->children_observer) |
| { |
| if (prev_previous) |
| g_warning ("oops"); |
| else |
| gtk_list_list_model_item_added (parent->priv->children_observer, widget); |
| } |
| |
| if (parent->priv->root && priv->root == NULL) |
| gtk_widget_root (widget); |
| |
| if (prev_parent == NULL) |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_PARENT]); |
| |
| /* Enforce realized/mapped invariants |
| */ |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) |
| gtk_widget_realize (widget); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (priv->parent) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| { |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_child_visible (widget) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent)) |
| gtk_widget_map (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (priv->parent); |
| } |
| |
| /* child may cause parent's expand to change, if the child is |
| * expanded. If child is not expanded, then it can't modify the |
| * parent's expand. If the child becomes expanded later then it will |
| * queue compute_expand then. This optimization plus defaulting |
| * newly-constructed widgets to need_compute_expand=FALSE should |
| * mean that initially building a widget tree doesn't have to keep |
| * walking up setting need_compute_expand on parents over and over. |
| * |
| * We can't change a parent to need to expand unless we're visible. |
| */ |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && |
| (priv->need_compute_expand || |
| priv->computed_hexpand || |
| priv->computed_vexpand)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (parent); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_parent: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @parent: parent widget |
| * |
| * This function is useful only when implementing subclasses of |
| * #GtkWidget. |
| * Sets @parent as the parent widget of @widget, and takes care of |
| * some details such as updating the state and style of the child |
| * to reflect its new location and resizing the parent. The opposite |
| * function is gtk_widget_unparent(). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_parent (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *parent) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); |
| g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_parent (widget) == NULL); |
| |
| gtk_widget_reposition_after (widget, |
| parent, |
| _gtk_widget_get_last_child (parent)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_parent: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the parent widget of @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the parent widget of @widget, or %NULL |
| **/ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_parent (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->parent; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_root: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the #GtkRoot widget of @widget or %NULL if the widget is not contained |
| * inside a widget tree with a root widget. |
| * |
| * #GtkRoot widgets will return themselves here. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the root widget of @widget, or %NULL |
| **/ |
| GtkRoot * |
| gtk_widget_get_root (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return _gtk_widget_get_root (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_direction_changed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTextDirection previous_direction) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| reset_style_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| gtk_css_node_invalidate (priv->cssnode, GTK_CSS_CHANGE_ANY); |
| |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, reset_style_recurse, user_data); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_reset_style: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Updates the style context of @widget and all descendants |
| * by updating its widget path. #GtkContainers may want |
| * to use this on a child when reordering it in a way that a different |
| * style might apply to it. See also gtk_container_get_path_for_child(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_reset_style (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| reset_style_recurse (widget, NULL); |
| |
| g_list_foreach (priv->attached_windows, |
| (GFunc) reset_style_recurse, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS |
| |
| /* Verify invariants, see docs/widget_system.txt for notes on much of |
| * this. Invariants may be temporarily broken while we’re in the |
| * process of updating state, of course, so you can only |
| * verify_invariants() after a given operation is complete. |
| * Use push/pop_verify_invariants to help with that. |
| */ |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| |
| if (priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0) |
| return; |
| |
| parent = priv->parent; |
| |
| if (priv->mapped) |
| { |
| /* Mapped implies ... */ |
| |
| if (!priv->realized) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not realized", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| |
| if (!priv->visible) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not visible", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| { |
| if (!priv->child_visible) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but not child_visible", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Not mapped implies... */ |
| |
| #if 0 |
| /* This check makes sense for normal toplevels, but for |
| * something like a toplevel that is embedded within a clutter |
| * state, mapping may depend on external factors. |
| */ |
| if (widget->priv->toplevel) |
| { |
| if (widget->priv->visible) |
| g_warning ("%s %p toplevel is visible but not mapped", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| /* Parent related checks aren't possible if parent has |
| * verifying_invariants_count > 0 because parent needs to recurse |
| * children first before the invariants will hold. |
| */ |
| if (parent == NULL || parent->priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0) |
| { |
| if (parent && |
| parent->priv->realized) |
| { |
| /* Parent realized implies... */ |
| |
| #if 0 |
| /* This is in widget_system.txt but appears to fail |
| * because there's no gtk_container_realize() that |
| * realizes all children... instead we just lazily |
| * wait for map to fix things up. |
| */ |
| if (!widget->priv->realized) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is realized but child %s %p is not realized", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent, |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| #endif |
| } |
| else if (!GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| { |
| /* No parent or parent not realized on non-toplevel implies... */ |
| |
| if (priv->realized) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is not realized but child %s %p is realized", |
| parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent, |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| } |
| |
| if (parent && |
| parent->priv->mapped && |
| priv->visible && |
| priv->child_visible) |
| { |
| /* Parent mapped and we are visible implies... */ |
| |
| if (!priv->mapped) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible child %s %p is not mapped", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent), parent, |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| } |
| else if (!GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| { |
| /* No parent or parent not mapped on non-toplevel implies... */ |
| |
| if (priv->mapped) |
| g_warning ("%s %p is mapped but visible=%d child_visible=%d parent %s %p mapped=%d", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget, |
| priv->visible, |
| priv->child_visible, |
| parent ? G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (parent) : "no parent", parent, |
| parent ? parent->priv->mapped : FALSE); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (!priv->realized) |
| { |
| /* Not realized implies... */ |
| |
| #if 0 |
| /* widget_system.txt says these hold, but they don't. */ |
| if (widget->priv->alloc_needed) |
| g_warning ("%s %p alloc needed but not realized", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| |
| if (widget->priv->width_request_needed) |
| g_warning ("%s %p width request needed but not realized", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| |
| if (widget->priv->height_request_needed) |
| g_warning ("%s %p height request needed but not realized", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| #endif |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* The point of this push/pop is that invariants may not hold while |
| * we’re busy making changes. So we only check at the outermost call |
| * on the call stack, after we finish updating everything. |
| */ |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_push_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->verifying_invariants_count += 1; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| /* We don't recurse further; this is a one-level check. */ |
| gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_pop_verify_invariants (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_assert (priv->verifying_invariants_count > 0); |
| |
| priv->verifying_invariants_count -= 1; |
| |
| if (priv->verifying_invariants_count == 0) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| /* Check one level of children, because our |
| * push_verify_invariants() will have prevented some of the |
| * checks. This does not recurse because if recursion is |
| * needed, it will happen naturally as each child has a |
| * push/pop on that child. For example if we're recursively |
| * mapping children, we'll push/pop on each child as we map |
| * it. |
| */ |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_verify_child_invariants (child); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ |
| |
| static PangoContext * |
| gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_pango_context: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets a #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, font description, |
| * and base direction for this widget. Unlike the context returned |
| * by gtk_widget_create_pango_context(), this context is owned by |
| * the widget (it can be used until the screen for the widget changes |
| * or the widget is removed from its toplevel), and will be updated to |
| * match any changes to the widget’s attributes. This can be tracked |
| * by using the #GtkWidget::display-changed signal on the widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the #PangoContext for the widget. |
| **/ |
| PangoContext * |
| gtk_widget_get_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| PangoContext *context; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| context = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_pango_context); |
| if (!context) |
| { |
| context = gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GTK_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), |
| quark_pango_context, |
| context, |
| g_object_unref); |
| } |
| |
| return context; |
| } |
| |
| static PangoFontMap * |
| gtk_widget_get_effective_font_map (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| PangoFontMap *font_map; |
| |
| font_map = PANGO_FONT_MAP (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)); |
| if (font_map) |
| return font_map; |
| else if (priv->parent) |
| return gtk_widget_get_effective_font_map (priv->parent); |
| else |
| return pango_cairo_font_map_get_default (); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget, |
| PangoContext *context) |
| { |
| PangoFontDescription *font_desc; |
| GtkStyleContext *style_context; |
| GtkSettings *settings; |
| cairo_font_options_t *font_options; |
| GtkCssValue *value; |
| char *variations; |
| |
| style_context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); |
| gtk_style_context_get (style_context, |
| "font", &font_desc, |
| NULL); |
| |
| value = _gtk_style_context_peek_property (_gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget), GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_FONT_VARIATION_SETTINGS); |
| variations = gtk_css_font_variations_value_get_variations (value); |
| |
| pango_font_description_set_variations (font_desc, variations); |
| |
| pango_context_set_font_description (context, font_desc); |
| |
| pango_font_description_free (font_desc); |
| g_free (variations); |
| |
| pango_context_set_base_dir (context, |
| _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget) == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR ? |
| PANGO_DIRECTION_LTR : PANGO_DIRECTION_RTL); |
| |
| pango_cairo_context_set_resolution (context, |
| _gtk_css_number_value_get ( |
| _gtk_style_context_peek_property (style_context, |
| GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_DPI), |
| 100)); |
| |
| settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (widget); |
| font_options = (cairo_font_options_t*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options); |
| if (settings && font_options) |
| { |
| cairo_font_options_t *options; |
| |
| options = cairo_font_options_copy (gtk_settings_get_font_options (settings)); |
| cairo_font_options_merge (options, font_options); |
| pango_cairo_context_set_font_options (context, options); |
| cairo_font_options_destroy (options); |
| } |
| else if (settings) |
| { |
| pango_cairo_context_set_font_options (context, |
| gtk_settings_get_font_options (settings)); |
| } |
| |
| pango_context_set_font_map (context, gtk_widget_get_effective_font_map (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| PangoContext *context = gtk_widget_peek_pango_context (widget); |
| |
| if (context) |
| update_pango_context (widget, context); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_font_options: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @options: (allow-none): a #cairo_font_options_t, or %NULL to unset any |
| * previously set default font options. |
| * |
| * Sets the #cairo_font_options_t used for Pango rendering in this widget. |
| * When not set, the default font options for the #GdkDisplay will be used. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_font_options (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const cairo_font_options_t *options) |
| { |
| cairo_font_options_t *font_options; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| font_options = (cairo_font_options_t *)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options); |
| if (font_options != options) |
| { |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), |
| quark_font_options, |
| options ? cairo_font_options_copy (options) : NULL, |
| (GDestroyNotify)cairo_font_options_destroy); |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_font_options: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the #cairo_font_options_t used for Pango rendering. When not set, |
| * the defaults font options for the #GdkDisplay will be used. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the #cairo_font_options_t or %NULL if not set |
| **/ |
| const cairo_font_options_t * |
| gtk_widget_get_font_options (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return (cairo_font_options_t *)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_options); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_font_map_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, gtk_widget_set_font_map_recurse, user_data); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_font_map: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @font_map: (allow-none): a #PangoFontMap, or %NULL to unset any previously |
| * set font map |
| * |
| * Sets the font map to use for Pango rendering. When not set, the widget |
| * will inherit the font map from its parent. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_font_map (GtkWidget *widget, |
| PangoFontMap *font_map) |
| { |
| PangoFontMap *map; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| map = PANGO_FONT_MAP (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)); |
| if (map == font_map) |
| return; |
| |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), |
| quark_font_map, |
| g_object_ref (font_map), |
| g_object_unref); |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, gtk_widget_set_font_map_recurse, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_font_map: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the font map that has been set with gtk_widget_set_font_map(). |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): A #PangoFontMap, or %NULL |
| */ |
| PangoFontMap * |
| gtk_widget_get_font_map (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return PANGO_FONT_MAP (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_font_map)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_create_pango_context: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Creates a new #PangoContext with the appropriate font map, |
| * font options, font description, and base direction for drawing |
| * text for this widget. See also gtk_widget_get_pango_context(). |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer full): the new #PangoContext |
| **/ |
| PangoContext * |
| gtk_widget_create_pango_context (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| PangoContext *context; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| context = pango_font_map_create_context (pango_cairo_font_map_get_default ()); |
| update_pango_context (widget, context); |
| pango_context_set_language (context, gtk_get_default_language ()); |
| |
| return context; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_create_pango_layout: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @text: (nullable): text to set on the layout (can be %NULL) |
| * |
| * Creates a new #PangoLayout with the appropriate font map, |
| * font description, and base direction for drawing text for |
| * this widget. |
| * |
| * If you keep a #PangoLayout created in this way around, you need |
| * to re-create it when the widget #PangoContext is replaced. |
| * This can be tracked by using the #GtkWidget::display-changed signal |
| * on the widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer full): the new #PangoLayout |
| **/ |
| PangoLayout * |
| gtk_widget_create_pango_layout (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *text) |
| { |
| PangoLayout *layout; |
| PangoContext *context; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| context = gtk_widget_get_pango_context (widget); |
| layout = pango_layout_new (context); |
| |
| if (text) |
| pango_layout_set_text (layout, text, -1); |
| |
| return layout; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_child_visible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @child_visible: if %TRUE, @widget should be mapped along with its parent. |
| * |
| * Sets whether @widget should be mapped along with its when its parent |
| * is mapped and @widget has been shown with gtk_widget_show(). |
| * |
| * The child visibility can be set for widget before it is added to |
| * a container with gtk_widget_set_parent(), to avoid mapping |
| * children unnecessary before immediately unmapping them. However |
| * it will be reset to its default state of %TRUE when the widget |
| * is removed from a container. |
| * |
| * Note that changing the child visibility of a widget does not |
| * queue a resize on the widget. Most of the time, the size of |
| * a widget is computed from all visible children, whether or |
| * not they are mapped. If this is not the case, the container |
| * can queue a resize itself. |
| * |
| * This function is only useful for container implementations and |
| * never should be called by an application. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean child_visible) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (!_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)); |
| |
| child_visible = !!child_visible; |
| |
| if (priv->child_visible == child_visible) |
| return; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); |
| |
| if (child_visible) |
| priv->child_visible = TRUE; |
| else |
| { |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| |
| priv->child_visible = FALSE; |
| |
| toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| if (toplevel != widget && _gtk_widget_is_toplevel (toplevel)) |
| _gtk_window_unset_focus_and_default (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget); |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->parent && _gtk_widget_get_realized (priv->parent)) |
| { |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (priv->parent) && |
| priv->child_visible && |
| _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_map (widget); |
| else |
| gtk_widget_unmap (widget); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_verify_invariants (widget); |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_child_visible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value set with gtk_widget_set_child_visible(). |
| * If you feel a need to use this function, your code probably |
| * needs reorganization. |
| * |
| * This function is only useful for container implementations and |
| * never should be called by an application. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the widget is mapped with the parent. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_child_visible (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->child_visible; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_scale_changed (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->context) |
| gtk_style_context_set_scale (priv->context, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_SCALE_FACTOR]); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, (GtkCallback)_gtk_widget_scale_changed, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_scale_factor: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Retrieves the internal scale factor that maps from window coordinates |
| * to the actual device pixels. On traditional systems this is 1, on |
| * high density outputs, it can be a higher value (typically 2). |
| * |
| * See gdk_surface_get_scale_factor(). |
| * |
| * Returns: the scale factor for @widget |
| */ |
| gint |
| gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| GdkDisplay *display; |
| GdkMonitor *monitor; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 1); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| return gdk_surface_get_scale_factor (_gtk_widget_get_surface (widget)); |
| |
| toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| if (toplevel && toplevel != widget) |
| return gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (toplevel); |
| |
| /* else fall back to something that is more likely to be right than |
| * just returning 1: |
| */ |
| display = _gtk_widget_get_display (widget); |
| monitor = gdk_display_get_monitor (display, 0); |
| |
| if (monitor) |
| return gdk_monitor_get_scale_factor (monitor); |
| |
| return 1; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_display: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Get the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel window associated with |
| * this widget. This function can only be called after the widget |
| * has been added to a widget hierarchy with a #GtkWindow at the top. |
| * |
| * In general, you should only create display specific |
| * resources when a widget has been realized, and you should |
| * free those resources when the widget is unrealized. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the #GdkDisplay for the toplevel for this widget. |
| **/ |
| GdkDisplay* |
| gtk_widget_get_display (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return _gtk_widget_get_display (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_child_focus: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @direction: direction of focus movement |
| * |
| * This function is used by custom widget implementations; if you're |
| * writing an app, you’d use gtk_widget_grab_focus() to move the focus |
| * to a particular widget. |
| * |
| * gtk_widget_child_focus() is called by containers as the user moves |
| * around the window using keyboard shortcuts. @direction indicates |
| * what kind of motion is taking place (up, down, left, right, tab |
| * forward, tab backward). gtk_widget_child_focus() emits the |
| * #GtkWidget::focus signal; widgets override the default handler |
| * for this signal in order to implement appropriate focus behavior. |
| * |
| * The default ::focus handler for a widget should return %TRUE if |
| * moving in @direction left the focus on a focusable location inside |
| * that widget, and %FALSE if moving in @direction moved the focus |
| * outside the widget. If returning %TRUE, widgets normally |
| * call gtk_widget_grab_focus() to place the focus accordingly; |
| * if returning %FALSE, they don’t modify the current focus location. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if focus ended up inside @widget |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_child_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) || |
| !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| /* Emit ::focus in any case, even if can-focus is FALSE, |
| * since any widget might have child widgets that will take |
| * focus |
| */ |
| |
| return GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->focus (widget, direction); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_keynav_failed: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @direction: direction of focus movement |
| * |
| * This function should be called whenever keyboard navigation within |
| * a single widget hits a boundary. The function emits the |
| * #GtkWidget::keynav-failed signal on the widget and its return |
| * value should be interpreted in a way similar to the return value of |
| * gtk_widget_child_focus(): |
| * |
| * When %TRUE is returned, stay in the widget, the failed keyboard |
| * navigation is OK and/or there is nowhere we can/should move the |
| * focus to. |
| * |
| * When %FALSE is returned, the caller should continue with keyboard |
| * navigation outside the widget, e.g. by calling |
| * gtk_widget_child_focus() on the widget’s toplevel. |
| * |
| * The default ::keynav-failed handler returns %FALSE for |
| * %GTK_DIR_TAB_FORWARD and %GTK_DIR_TAB_BACKWARD. For the other |
| * values of #GtkDirectionType it returns %TRUE. |
| * |
| * Whenever the default handler returns %TRUE, it also calls |
| * gtk_widget_error_bell() to notify the user of the failed keyboard |
| * navigation. |
| * |
| * A use case for providing an own implementation of ::keynav-failed |
| * (either by connecting to it or by overriding it) would be a row of |
| * #GtkEntry widgets where the user should be able to navigate the |
| * entire row with the cursor keys, as e.g. known from user interfaces |
| * that require entering license keys. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if stopping keyboard navigation is fine, %FALSE |
| * if the emitting widget should try to handle the keyboard |
| * navigation attempt in its parent container(s). |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_keynav_failed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkDirectionType direction) |
| { |
| gboolean return_val; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[KEYNAV_FAILED], 0, |
| direction, &return_val); |
| |
| return return_val; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_error_bell: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Notifies the user about an input-related error on this widget. |
| * If the #GtkSettings:gtk-error-bell setting is %TRUE, it calls |
| * gdk_surface_beep(), otherwise it does nothing. |
| * |
| * Note that the effect of gdk_surface_beep() can be configured in many |
| * ways, depending on the windowing backend and the desktop environment |
| * or window manager that is used. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_error_bell (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkSettings* settings; |
| gboolean beep; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| settings = gtk_widget_get_settings (widget); |
| if (!settings) |
| return; |
| |
| g_object_get (settings, |
| "gtk-error-bell", &beep, |
| NULL); |
| |
| if (beep && priv->surface) |
| gdk_surface_beep (priv->surface); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint width, |
| gint height) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gboolean changed = FALSE; |
| |
| g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| |
| if (width > -2 && priv->width_request != width) |
| { |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_WIDTH_REQUEST]); |
| priv->width_request = width; |
| changed = TRUE; |
| } |
| if (height > -2 && priv->height_request != height) |
| { |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HEIGHT_REQUEST]); |
| priv->height_request = height; |
| changed = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget) && changed) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| } |
| |
| g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @width: width @widget should request, or -1 to unset |
| * @height: height @widget should request, or -1 to unset |
| * |
| * Sets the minimum size of a widget; that is, the widget’s size |
| * request will be at least @width by @height. You can use this |
| * function to force a widget to be larger than it normally would be. |
| * |
| * In most cases, gtk_window_set_default_size() is a better choice for |
| * toplevel windows than this function; setting the default size will |
| * still allow users to shrink the window. Setting the size request |
| * will force them to leave the window at least as large as the size |
| * request. When dealing with window sizes, |
| * gtk_window_set_geometry_hints() can be a useful function as well. |
| * |
| * Note the inherent danger of setting any fixed size - themes, |
| * translations into other languages, different fonts, and user action |
| * can all change the appropriate size for a given widget. So, it's |
| * basically impossible to hardcode a size that will always be |
| * correct. |
| * |
| * The size request of a widget is the smallest size a widget can |
| * accept while still functioning well and drawing itself correctly. |
| * However in some strange cases a widget may be allocated less than |
| * its requested size, and in many cases a widget may be allocated more |
| * space than it requested. |
| * |
| * If the size request in a given direction is -1 (unset), then |
| * the “natural” size request of the widget will be used instead. |
| * |
| * The size request set here does not include any margin from the |
| * #GtkWidget properties margin-left, margin-right, margin-top, and |
| * margin-bottom, but it does include pretty much all other padding |
| * or border properties set by any subclass of #GtkWidget. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint width, |
| gint height) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (width >= -1); |
| g_return_if_fail (height >= -1); |
| |
| gtk_widget_set_usize_internal (widget, width, height); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_size_request: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @width: (out) (allow-none): return location for width, or %NULL |
| * @height: (out) (allow-none): return location for height, or %NULL |
| * |
| * Gets the size request that was explicitly set for the widget using |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). A value of -1 stored in @width or |
| * @height indicates that that dimension has not been set explicitly |
| * and the natural requisition of the widget will be used instead. See |
| * gtk_widget_set_size_request(). To get the size a widget will |
| * actually request, call gtk_widget_measure() instead of |
| * this function. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_get_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint *width, |
| gint *height) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (width) |
| *width = priv->width_request; |
| |
| if (height) |
| *height = priv->height_request; |
| } |
| |
| /*< private > |
| * gtk_widget_has_size_request: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns if the widget has a size request set (anything besides -1 for height |
| * or width) |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_has_size_request (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return !(priv->width_request == -1 && priv->height_request == -1); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_toplevel: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This function returns the topmost widget in the container hierarchy |
| * @widget is a part of. If @widget has no parent widgets, it will be |
| * returned as the topmost widget. No reference will be added to the |
| * returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. |
| * |
| * Note the difference in behavior vs. gtk_widget_get_ancestor(); |
| * `gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_WINDOW)` |
| * would return |
| * %NULL if @widget wasn’t inside a toplevel window, and if the |
| * window was inside a #GtkWindow-derived widget which was in turn |
| * inside the toplevel #GtkWindow. |
| * |
| * To reliably find the toplevel #GtkWindow, use |
| * gtk_widget_get_toplevel() and call GTK_IS_WINDOW() |
| * on the result. For instance, to get the title of a widget's toplevel |
| * window, one might use: |
| * |[<!-- language="C" --> |
| * static const char * |
| * get_widget_toplevel_title (GtkWidget *widget) |
| * { |
| * GtkWidget *toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| * if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) |
| * { |
| * return gtk_window_get_title (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel)); |
| * } |
| * |
| * return NULL; |
| * } |
| * ]| |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the topmost ancestor of @widget, or @widget itself |
| * if there’s no ancestor. |
| **/ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| while (priv->parent) |
| { |
| widget = priv->parent; |
| priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| } |
| |
| return widget; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_ancestor: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @widget_type: ancestor type |
| * |
| * Gets the first ancestor of @widget with type @widget_type. For example, |
| * `gtk_widget_get_ancestor (widget, GTK_TYPE_BOX)` gets |
| * the first #GtkBox that’s an ancestor of @widget. No reference will be |
| * added to the returned widget; it should not be unreferenced. See note |
| * about checking for a toplevel #GtkWindow in the docs for |
| * gtk_widget_get_toplevel(). |
| * |
| * Note that unlike gtk_widget_is_ancestor(), gtk_widget_get_ancestor() |
| * considers @widget to be an ancestor of itself. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): the ancestor widget, or %NULL if not found |
| **/ |
| GtkWidget* |
| gtk_widget_get_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GType widget_type) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| while (widget && !g_type_is_a (G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget), widget_type)) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| widget = priv->parent; |
| } |
| |
| return widget; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_settings: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the settings object holding the settings used for this widget. |
| * |
| * Note that this function can only be called when the #GtkWidget |
| * is attached to a toplevel, since the settings object is specific |
| * to a particular #GdkDisplay. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the relevant #GtkSettings object |
| */ |
| GtkSettings* |
| gtk_widget_get_settings (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return gtk_settings_get_for_display (_gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_is_ancestor: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @ancestor: another #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Determines whether @widget is somewhere inside @ancestor, possibly with |
| * intermediate containers. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @ancestor contains @widget as a child, |
| * grandchild, great grandchild, etc. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_is_ancestor (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *ancestor) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (ancestor != NULL, FALSE); |
| |
| while (widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->parent == ancestor) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| widget = priv->parent; |
| } |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTextDirection old_dir) |
| { |
| GtkTextDirection direction; |
| GtkStateFlags state; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_pango_context (widget); |
| |
| direction = _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget); |
| |
| switch (direction) |
| { |
| case GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR: |
| state = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR; |
| break; |
| |
| case GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL: |
| state = GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL; |
| break; |
| |
| case GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE: |
| default: |
| g_assert_not_reached (); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_state_flags (widget, |
| state, |
| state ^ (GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_LTR | GTK_STATE_FLAG_DIR_RTL)); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[DIRECTION_CHANGED], 0, old_dir); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_direction: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @dir: the new direction |
| * |
| * Sets the reading direction on a particular widget. This direction |
| * controls the primary direction for widgets containing text, |
| * and also the direction in which the children of a container are |
| * packed. The ability to set the direction is present in order |
| * so that correct localization into languages with right-to-left |
| * reading directions can be done. Generally, applications will |
| * let the default reading direction present, except for containers |
| * where the containers are arranged in an order that is explicitly |
| * visual rather than logical (such as buttons for text justification). |
| * |
| * If the direction is set to %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE, then the value |
| * set by gtk_widget_set_default_direction() will be used. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_direction (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTextDirection dir) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkTextDirection old_dir; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (dir >= GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE && dir <= GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL); |
| |
| old_dir = _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget); |
| |
| priv->direction = dir; |
| |
| if (old_dir != _gtk_widget_get_direction (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_direction: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the reading direction for a particular widget. See |
| * gtk_widget_set_direction(). |
| * |
| * Returns: the reading direction for the widget. |
| **/ |
| GtkTextDirection |
| gtk_widget_get_direction (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR); |
| |
| if (priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE) |
| return gtk_default_direction; |
| else |
| return priv->direction; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkTextDirection old_dir) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->direction == GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE) |
| gtk_widget_emit_direction_changed (widget, old_dir); |
| |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (child, old_dir); |
| } |
| |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_default_direction: |
| * @dir: the new default direction. This cannot be |
| * %GTK_TEXT_DIR_NONE. |
| * |
| * Sets the default reading direction for widgets where the |
| * direction has not been explicitly set by gtk_widget_set_direction(). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_default_direction (GtkTextDirection dir) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_RTL || dir == GTK_TEXT_DIR_LTR); |
| |
| if (dir != gtk_default_direction) |
| { |
| GList *toplevels, *tmp_list; |
| GtkTextDirection old_dir = gtk_default_direction; |
| |
| gtk_default_direction = dir; |
| |
| tmp_list = toplevels = gtk_window_list_toplevels (); |
| g_list_foreach (toplevels, (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL); |
| |
| while (tmp_list) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_set_default_direction_recurse (tmp_list->data, old_dir); |
| g_object_unref (tmp_list->data); |
| tmp_list = tmp_list->next; |
| } |
| |
| g_list_free (toplevels); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_default_direction: |
| * |
| * Obtains the current default reading direction. See |
| * gtk_widget_set_default_direction(). |
| * |
| * Returns: the current default direction. |
| **/ |
| GtkTextDirection |
| gtk_widget_get_default_direction (void) |
| { |
| return gtk_default_direction; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_constructed (GObject *object) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidgetPath *path; |
| |
| /* As strange as it may seem, this may happen on object construction. |
| * init() implementations of parent types may eventually call this function, |
| * each with its corresponding GType, which could leave a child |
| * implementation with a wrong widget type in the widget path |
| */ |
| path = (GtkWidgetPath*)g_object_get_qdata (object, quark_widget_path); |
| if (path && G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget) != gtk_widget_path_get_object_type (path)) |
| g_object_set_qdata (object, quark_widget_path, NULL); |
| |
| G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->constructed (object); |
| |
| if (!priv->no_surface_set) |
| { |
| g_warning ("%s does not call gtk_widget_set_has_surface() in its init function", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_dispose (GObject *object) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *sizegroups; |
| |
| if (priv->children_observer) |
| gtk_list_list_model_clear (priv->children_observer); |
| if (priv->controller_observer) |
| gtk_list_list_model_clear (priv->controller_observer); |
| |
| if (priv->parent && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (priv->parent)) |
| gtk_container_remove (GTK_CONTAINER (priv->parent), widget); |
| else if (priv->parent) |
| gtk_widget_unparent (widget); |
| else if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_hide (widget); |
| |
| while (priv->paintables) |
| gtk_widget_paintable_set_widget (priv->paintables->data, NULL); |
| |
| if (priv->layout_manager != NULL) |
| gtk_layout_manager_set_widget (priv->layout_manager, NULL); |
| g_clear_object (&priv->layout_manager); |
| |
| priv->visible = FALSE; |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_unrealize (widget); |
| |
| g_clear_object (&priv->cursor); |
| |
| if (!priv->in_destruction) |
| { |
| priv->in_destruction = TRUE; |
| g_signal_emit (object, widget_signals[DESTROY], 0); |
| priv->in_destruction = FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| sizegroups = _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (widget); |
| while (sizegroups) |
| { |
| GtkSizeGroup *size_group; |
| |
| size_group = sizegroups->data; |
| sizegroups = sizegroups->next; |
| gtk_size_group_remove_widget (size_group, widget); |
| } |
| |
| g_object_set_qdata (object, quark_action_muxer, NULL); |
| |
| while (priv->attached_windows) |
| gtk_window_set_attached_to (priv->attached_windows->data, NULL); |
| |
| G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->dispose (object); |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS |
| typedef struct { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class; |
| GType widget_type; |
| GObject *object; |
| gboolean did_finalize; |
| } FinalizeAssertion; |
| |
| static void |
| finalize_assertion_weak_ref (gpointer data, |
| GObject *where_the_object_was) |
| { |
| FinalizeAssertion *assertion = (FinalizeAssertion *)data; |
| assertion->did_finalize = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| static FinalizeAssertion * |
| finalize_assertion_new (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GType widget_type, |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class) |
| { |
| FinalizeAssertion *assertion = NULL; |
| GObject *object; |
| |
| object = gtk_widget_get_template_child (widget, widget_type, child_class->name); |
| |
| /* We control the hash table entry, the object should never be NULL |
| */ |
| g_assert (object); |
| if (!G_IS_OBJECT (object)) |
| g_critical ("Automated component '%s' of class '%s' seems to have been prematurely finalized", |
| child_class->name, g_type_name (widget_type)); |
| else |
| { |
| assertion = g_slice_new0 (FinalizeAssertion); |
| assertion->child_class = child_class; |
| assertion->widget_type = widget_type; |
| assertion->object = object; |
| |
| g_object_weak_ref (object, finalize_assertion_weak_ref, assertion); |
| } |
| |
| return assertion; |
| } |
| |
| static GSList * |
| build_finalize_assertion_list (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GType class_type; |
| GtkWidgetClass *class; |
| GSList *l, *list = NULL; |
| |
| for (class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); |
| GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (class); |
| class = g_type_class_peek_parent (class)) |
| { |
| if (!class->priv->template) |
| continue; |
| |
| class_type = G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (class); |
| |
| for (l = class->priv->template->children; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; |
| FinalizeAssertion *assertion; |
| |
| assertion = finalize_assertion_new (widget, class_type, child_class); |
| list = g_slist_prepend (list, assertion); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| return list; |
| } |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_destroy (GtkWidget *object) |
| { |
| /* gtk_object_destroy() will already hold a refcount on object */ |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children)) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClass *class; |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS |
| GSList *assertions = NULL; |
| |
| /* Note, GTK_WIDGET_ASSERT_COMPONENTS is very useful |
| * to catch ref counting bugs, but can only be used in |
| * test cases which simply create and destroy a composite |
| * widget. |
| * |
| * This is because some API can expose components explicitly, |
| * and so we cannot assert that a component is expected to finalize |
| * in a full application ecosystem. |
| */ |
| if (g_getenv ("GTK_WIDGET_ASSERT_COMPONENTS") != NULL) |
| assertions = build_finalize_assertion_list (widget); |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ |
| |
| /* Release references to all automated children */ |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children, NULL); |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS |
| for (l = assertions; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| FinalizeAssertion *assertion = l->data; |
| |
| if (!assertion->did_finalize) |
| g_critical ("Automated component '%s' of class '%s' did not finalize in gtk_widget_destroy(). " |
| "Current reference count is %d", |
| assertion->child_class->name, |
| g_type_name (assertion->widget_type), |
| assertion->object->ref_count); |
| |
| g_slice_free (FinalizeAssertion, assertion); |
| } |
| g_slist_free (assertions); |
| #endif /* G_ENABLE_CONSISTENCY_CHECKS */ |
| |
| /* Set any automatic private data pointers to NULL */ |
| for (class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); |
| GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (class); |
| class = g_type_class_peek_parent (class)) |
| { |
| if (!class->priv->template) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (l = class->priv->template->children; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; |
| |
| if (child_class->offset != 0) |
| { |
| gpointer field_p; |
| |
| /* Nullify instance private data for internal children */ |
| field_p = G_STRUCT_MEMBER_P (widget, child_class->offset); |
| (* (gpointer *) field_p) = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->accessible) |
| { |
| gtk_accessible_set_widget (GTK_ACCESSIBLE (priv->accessible), NULL); |
| g_object_unref (priv->accessible); |
| priv->accessible = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* wipe accelerator closures (keep order) */ |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_path, NULL); |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_accel_closures, NULL); |
| |
| /* Callers of add_mnemonic_label() should disconnect on ::destroy */ |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, NULL); |
| |
| gtk_grab_remove (widget); |
| |
| destroy_tick_callbacks (widget); |
| destroy_surface_transform_data (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_finalize (GObject *object) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *widget = GTK_WIDGET (object); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| gtk_grab_remove (widget); |
| |
| g_free (priv->name); |
| |
| g_clear_object (&priv->accessible); |
| |
| gtk_widget_clear_path (widget); |
| |
| gtk_css_widget_node_widget_destroyed (GTK_CSS_WIDGET_NODE (priv->cssnode)); |
| g_object_unref (priv->cssnode); |
| |
| g_clear_object (&priv->context); |
| |
| _gtk_size_request_cache_free (&priv->requests); |
| |
| l = priv->event_controllers; |
| while (l) |
| { |
| GList *next = l->next; |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (controller) |
| gtk_widget_remove_controller (widget, controller); |
| |
| l = next; |
| } |
| g_assert (priv->event_controllers == NULL); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget) != NULL) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| g_warning ("Finalizing %s %p, but it still has children left:", |
| gtk_widget_get_name (widget), widget); |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| g_warning (" - %s %p", gtk_widget_get_name (child), child); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| if (g_object_is_floating (object)) |
| g_warning ("A floating object was finalized. This means that someone\n" |
| "called g_object_unref() on an object that had only a floating\n" |
| "reference; the initial floating reference is not owned by anyone\n" |
| "and must be removed with g_object_ref_sink()."); |
| |
| G_OBJECT_CLASS (gtk_widget_parent_class)->finalize (object); |
| } |
| |
| /***************************************** |
| * gtk_widget_real_map: |
| * |
| * arguments: |
| * |
| * results: |
| *****************************************/ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_map (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_assert (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *p; |
| priv->mapped = TRUE; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| gdk_surface_show (priv->surface); |
| |
| for (p = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| p != NULL; |
| p = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (p)) |
| { |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_visible (p) && |
| _gtk_widget_get_child_visible (p) && |
| !_gtk_widget_get_mapped (p)) |
| gtk_widget_map (p); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /***************************************** |
| * gtk_widget_real_unmap: |
| * |
| * arguments: |
| * |
| * results: |
| *****************************************/ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_unmap (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| priv->mapped = FALSE; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| gdk_surface_hide (priv->surface); |
| |
| for (child = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_unmap (child); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_paintables (widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_unset_state_flags (widget, |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_PRELIGHT | |
| GTK_STATE_FLAG_ACTIVE); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /***************************************** |
| * gtk_widget_real_realize: |
| * |
| * arguments: |
| * |
| * results: |
| *****************************************/ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_realize (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| { |
| g_assert (priv->surface != NULL); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| g_assert (priv->parent); |
| priv->surface = priv->parent->priv->surface; |
| g_object_ref (priv->surface); |
| } |
| |
| priv->realized = TRUE; |
| |
| gtk_widget_connect_frame_clock (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /***************************************** |
| * gtk_widget_real_unrealize: |
| * |
| * arguments: |
| * |
| * results: |
| *****************************************/ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_unrealize (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_assert (!priv->mapped); |
| |
| /* We must do unrealize child widget BEFORE container widget. |
| * gdk_surface_destroy() destroys specified xwindow and its sub-xwindows. |
| * So, unrealizing container widget before its children causes the problem |
| * (for example, gdk_ic_destroy () with destroyed window causes crash.) |
| */ |
| |
| gtk_widget_forall (widget, (GtkCallback)gtk_widget_unrealize, NULL); |
| |
| gtk_widget_disconnect_frame_clock (widget); |
| |
| priv->realized = FALSE; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_unregister_surface (widget, priv->surface); |
| gdk_surface_destroy (priv->surface); |
| priv->surface = NULL; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| g_object_unref (priv->surface); |
| priv->surface = NULL; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_adjust_size_request (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation, |
| gint *minimum_size, |
| gint *natural_size) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL && priv->width_request > 0) |
| *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, priv->width_request); |
| else if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL && priv->height_request > 0) |
| *minimum_size = MAX (*minimum_size, priv->height_request); |
| |
| /* Fix it if set_size_request made natural size smaller than min size. |
| * This would also silently fix broken widgets, but we warn about them |
| * in gtksizerequest.c when calling their size request vfuncs. |
| */ |
| *natural_size = MAX (*natural_size, *minimum_size); |
| |
| if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) |
| { |
| *minimum_size += priv->margin.left + priv->margin.right; |
| *natural_size += priv->margin.left + priv->margin.right; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| *minimum_size += priv->margin.top + priv->margin.bottom; |
| *natural_size += priv->margin.top + priv->margin.bottom; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_adjust_baseline_request (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint *minimum_baseline, |
| gint *natural_baseline) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->height_request >= 0) |
| { |
| /* No baseline support for explicitly set height */ |
| *minimum_baseline = -1; |
| *natural_baseline = -1; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| *minimum_baseline += priv->margin.top; |
| *natural_baseline += priv->margin.top; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| is_my_surface (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkSurface *surface) |
| { |
| if (!surface) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| return gdk_surface_get_widget (surface) == widget; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * _gtk_widget_get_device_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @device: a #GdkDevice |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable): the surface of @widget that @device is in, or %NULL |
| */ |
| GdkSurface * |
| _gtk_widget_get_device_surface (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkDevice *device) |
| { |
| GdkSurface *surface; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GDK_IS_DEVICE (device), NULL); |
| |
| if (gdk_device_get_source (device) == GDK_SOURCE_KEYBOARD) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| surface = gdk_device_get_last_event_surface (device); |
| if (surface && is_my_surface (widget, surface)) |
| return surface; |
| else |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * _gtk_widget_list_devices: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the list of pointer #GdkDevices that are currently |
| * on top of any surface belonging to @widget. Free the list |
| * with g_list_free(), the elements are owned by GTK+ and must |
| * not be freed. |
| */ |
| GList * |
| _gtk_widget_list_devices (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GdkSeat *seat; |
| GList *result = NULL; |
| GList *devices; |
| GList *l; |
| GdkDevice *device; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_mapped (widget)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| seat = gdk_display_get_default_seat (_gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); |
| device = gdk_seat_get_pointer (seat); |
| if (is_my_surface (widget, gdk_device_get_last_event_surface (device))) |
| result = g_list_prepend (result, device); |
| |
| devices = gdk_seat_get_slaves (seat, GDK_SEAT_CAPABILITY_ALL_POINTING); |
| for (l = devices; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| device = l->data; |
| if (is_my_surface (widget, gdk_device_get_last_event_surface (device))) |
| result = g_list_prepend (result, device); |
| } |
| g_list_free (devices); |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| synth_crossing (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventType type, |
| GdkSurface *surface, |
| GdkDevice *device, |
| GdkCrossingMode mode, |
| GdkNotifyType detail) |
| { |
| GdkEvent *event; |
| |
| event = gdk_event_new (type); |
| |
| event->any.surface = g_object_ref (surface); |
| event->any.send_event = TRUE; |
| event->crossing.child_surface = g_object_ref (surface); |
| event->crossing.time = GDK_CURRENT_TIME; |
| gdk_device_get_position (device, |
| &event->crossing.x_root, |
| &event->crossing.y_root); |
| gdk_surface_get_device_position (surface, |
| device, |
| &event->crossing.x, |
| &event->crossing.y, |
| NULL); |
| event->crossing.mode = mode; |
| event->crossing.detail = detail; |
| event->crossing.focus = FALSE; |
| event->crossing.state = 0; |
| gdk_event_set_device (event, device); |
| |
| if (!widget) |
| widget = gtk_get_event_widget (event); |
| |
| if (widget) |
| gtk_widget_event_internal (widget, event); |
| |
| g_object_unref (event); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing: |
| * @from: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is leaving. |
| * @to: the #GtkWidget the virtual pointer is moving to. |
| * @mode: the #GdkCrossingMode to place on the synthesized events. |
| * |
| * Generate crossing event(s) on widget state (sensitivity) or GTK+ grab change. |
| */ |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (GtkWidget *from, |
| GtkWidget *to, |
| GdkDevice *device, |
| GdkCrossingMode mode) |
| { |
| GdkSurface *from_surface = NULL, *to_surface = NULL; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (from != NULL || to != NULL); |
| |
| if (from != NULL) |
| { |
| from_surface = _gtk_widget_get_device_surface (from, device); |
| |
| if (!from_surface) |
| from_surface = from->priv->surface; |
| } |
| |
| if (to != NULL) |
| { |
| to_surface = _gtk_widget_get_device_surface (to, device); |
| |
| if (!to_surface) |
| to_surface = to->priv->surface; |
| } |
| |
| if (from_surface == NULL && to_surface == NULL) |
| ; |
| else if (from_surface != NULL && to_surface == NULL) |
| { |
| synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_surface, |
| device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); |
| } |
| else if (from_surface == NULL && to_surface != NULL) |
| { |
| synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_surface, |
| device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_ANCESTOR); |
| } |
| else if (from_surface == to_surface) |
| ; |
| else |
| { |
| synth_crossing (from, GDK_LEAVE_NOTIFY, from_surface, |
| device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR); |
| |
| synth_crossing (to, GDK_ENTER_NOTIFY, to_surface, |
| device, mode, GDK_NOTIFY_NONLINEAR); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_propagate_state (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const GtkStateData *data) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkStateFlags new_flags, old_flags = priv->state_flags; |
| GtkStateData child_data; |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| gint new_scale_factor = gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget); |
| |
| priv->state_flags |= data->flags_to_set; |
| priv->state_flags &= ~(data->flags_to_unset); |
| |
| /* make insensitivity unoverridable */ |
| if (!priv->sensitive) |
| priv->state_flags |= GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE; |
| |
| if (gtk_widget_is_focus (widget) && !gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) |
| gtk_root_set_focus (priv->root, NULL); |
| |
| new_flags = priv->state_flags; |
| |
| if (data->old_scale_factor != new_scale_factor) |
| _gtk_widget_scale_changed (widget); |
| |
| if (old_flags != new_flags) |
| { |
| g_object_ref (widget); |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget) && gtk_widget_has_grab (widget)) |
| gtk_grab_remove (widget); |
| |
| gtk_style_context_set_state (_gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget), new_flags); |
| |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STATE_FLAGS_CHANGED], 0, old_flags); |
| |
| if (!priv->shadowed && |
| (new_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE) != (old_flags & GTK_STATE_FLAG_INSENSITIVE)) |
| { |
| GList *event_surfaces = NULL; |
| GList *devices, *d; |
| |
| devices = _gtk_widget_list_devices (widget); |
| |
| for (d = devices; d; d = d->next) |
| { |
| GdkSurface *surface; |
| GdkDevice *device; |
| |
| device = d->data; |
| surface = _gtk_widget_get_device_surface (widget, device); |
| |
| /* Do not propagate more than once to the |
| * same surface if non-multidevice aware. |
| */ |
| if (!gdk_surface_get_support_multidevice (surface) && |
| g_list_find (event_surfaces, surface)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) |
| _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (widget, NULL, d->data, |
| GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED); |
| else |
| _gtk_widget_synthesize_crossing (NULL, widget, d->data, |
| GDK_CROSSING_STATE_CHANGED); |
| |
| event_surfaces = g_list_prepend (event_surfaces, surface); |
| } |
| |
| g_list_free (event_surfaces); |
| g_list_free (devices); |
| } |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_reset_controllers (widget); |
| |
| |
| /* Make sure to only propagate the right states further */ |
| child_data.old_scale_factor = new_scale_factor; |
| child_data.flags_to_set = data->flags_to_set & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_SET_PROPAGATE; |
| child_data.flags_to_unset = data->flags_to_unset & GTK_STATE_FLAGS_DO_UNSET_PROPAGATE; |
| |
| if (child_data.flags_to_set != 0 || |
| child_data.flags_to_unset != 0) |
| { |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_propagate_state (child, &child_data); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| g_object_unref (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_update_input_shape (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| /* set shape if widget has a GDK surface already. |
| * otherwise the shape is scheduled to be set by gtk_widget_realize(). |
| */ |
| if (priv->surface) |
| { |
| cairo_region_t *region; |
| cairo_region_t *csd_region; |
| cairo_region_t *app_region; |
| gboolean free_region; |
| |
| app_region = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info); |
| csd_region = g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (widget), "csd-region"); |
| |
| free_region = FALSE; |
| |
| if (app_region && csd_region) |
| { |
| free_region = TRUE; |
| region = cairo_region_copy (app_region); |
| cairo_region_intersect (region, csd_region); |
| } |
| else if (app_region) |
| region = app_region; |
| else if (csd_region) |
| region = csd_region; |
| else |
| region = NULL; |
| |
| gdk_surface_input_shape_combine_region (priv->surface, region, 0, 0); |
| |
| if (free_region) |
| cairo_region_destroy (region); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_csd_input_shape (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const cairo_region_t *region) |
| { |
| if (region == NULL) |
| g_object_set_data (G_OBJECT (widget), "csd-region", NULL); |
| else |
| g_object_set_data_full (G_OBJECT (widget), "csd-region", |
| cairo_region_copy (region), |
| (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); |
| gtk_widget_update_input_shape (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @region: (allow-none): shape to be added, or %NULL to remove an existing shape |
| * |
| * Sets an input shape for this widget’s GDK surface. This allows for |
| * windows which react to mouse click in a nonrectangular region, see |
| * gdk_surface_input_shape_combine_region() for more information. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_input_shape_combine_region (GtkWidget *widget, |
| cairo_region_t *region) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| /* set_shape doesn't work on widgets without GDK surface */ |
| g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_has_surface (widget)); |
| |
| if (region == NULL) |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, NULL); |
| else |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_input_shape_info, |
| cairo_region_copy (region), |
| (GDestroyNotify) cairo_region_destroy); |
| gtk_widget_update_input_shape (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_requisition_new: |
| * |
| * Allocates a new #GtkRequisition-struct and initializes its elements to zero. |
| * |
| * Returns: a new empty #GtkRequisition. The newly allocated #GtkRequisition should |
| * be freed with gtk_requisition_free(). |
| */ |
| GtkRequisition * |
| gtk_requisition_new (void) |
| { |
| return g_slice_new0 (GtkRequisition); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_requisition_copy: |
| * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition |
| * |
| * Copies a #GtkRequisition. |
| * |
| * Returns: a copy of @requisition |
| **/ |
| GtkRequisition * |
| gtk_requisition_copy (const GtkRequisition *requisition) |
| { |
| return g_slice_dup (GtkRequisition, requisition); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_requisition_free: |
| * @requisition: a #GtkRequisition |
| * |
| * Frees a #GtkRequisition. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_requisition_free (GtkRequisition *requisition) |
| { |
| g_slice_free (GtkRequisition, requisition); |
| } |
| |
| G_DEFINE_BOXED_TYPE (GtkRequisition, gtk_requisition, |
| gtk_requisition_copy, |
| gtk_requisition_free) |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type: |
| * @widget_class: class to set the accessible type for |
| * @type: The object type that implements the accessible for @widget_class |
| * |
| * Sets the type to be used for creating accessibles for widgets of |
| * @widget_class. The given @type must be a subtype of the type used for |
| * accessibles of the parent class. |
| * |
| * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| GType type) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, widget_class->priv->accessible_type)); |
| |
| priv = widget_class->priv; |
| |
| priv->accessible_type = type; |
| /* reset this - honoring the type's role is better. */ |
| priv->accessible_role = ATK_ROLE_INVALID; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_role: |
| * @widget_class: class to set the accessible role for |
| * @role: The role to use for accessibles created for @widget_class |
| * |
| * Sets the default #AtkRole to be set on accessibles created for |
| * widgets of @widget_class. Accessibles may decide to not honor this |
| * setting if their role reporting is more refined. Calls to |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type() will reset this value. |
| * |
| * In cases where you want more fine-grained control over the role of |
| * accessibles created for @widget_class, you should provide your own |
| * accessible type and use gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_type() |
| * instead. |
| * |
| * If @role is #ATK_ROLE_INVALID, the default role will not be changed |
| * and the accessible’s default role will be used instead. |
| * |
| * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_accessible_role (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| AtkRole role) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| |
| priv = widget_class->priv; |
| |
| priv->accessible_role = role; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * _gtk_widget_peek_accessible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the accessible for @widget, if it has been created yet. |
| * Otherwise, this function returns %NULL. If the @widget’s implementation |
| * does not use the default way to create accessibles, %NULL will always be |
| * returned. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable): the accessible for @widget or %NULL if none has been |
| * created yet. |
| **/ |
| AtkObject * |
| _gtk_widget_peek_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->accessible; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_accessible: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the accessible object that describes the widget to an |
| * assistive technology. |
| * |
| * If accessibility support is not available, this #AtkObject |
| * instance may be a no-op. Likewise, if no class-specific #AtkObject |
| * implementation is available for the widget instance in question, |
| * it will inherit an #AtkObject implementation from the first ancestor |
| * class for which such an implementation is defined. |
| * |
| * The documentation of the |
| * [ATK](http://developer.gnome.org/atk/stable/) |
| * library contains more information about accessible objects and their uses. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the #AtkObject associated with @widget |
| */ |
| AtkObject* |
| gtk_widget_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->get_accessible (widget); |
| } |
| |
| static AtkObject* |
| gtk_widget_real_get_accessible (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| AtkObject* accessible; |
| |
| accessible = widget->priv->accessible; |
| |
| if (!accessible) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClass *widget_class; |
| GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; |
| AtkObjectFactory *factory; |
| AtkRegistry *default_registry; |
| |
| widget_class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); |
| priv = widget_class->priv; |
| |
| if (priv->accessible_type == GTK_TYPE_ACCESSIBLE) |
| { |
| default_registry = atk_get_default_registry (); |
| factory = atk_registry_get_factory (default_registry, |
| G_TYPE_FROM_INSTANCE (widget)); |
| accessible = atk_object_factory_create_accessible (factory, G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) |
| atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role); |
| |
| widget->priv->accessible = accessible; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| accessible = g_object_new (priv->accessible_type, |
| "widget", widget, |
| NULL); |
| if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) |
| atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role); |
| |
| widget->priv->accessible = accessible; |
| |
| atk_object_initialize (accessible, widget); |
| |
| /* Set the role again, since we don't want a role set |
| * in some parent initialize() function to override |
| * our own. |
| */ |
| if (priv->accessible_role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) |
| atk_object_set_role (accessible, priv->accessible_role); |
| } |
| |
| } |
| |
| return accessible; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Initialize a AtkImplementorIface instance’s virtual pointers as |
| * appropriate to this implementor’s class (GtkWidget). |
| */ |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_accessible_interface_init (AtkImplementorIface *iface) |
| { |
| iface->ref_accessible = gtk_widget_ref_accessible; |
| } |
| |
| static AtkObject* |
| gtk_widget_ref_accessible (AtkImplementor *implementor) |
| { |
| AtkObject *accessible; |
| |
| accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (implementor)); |
| if (accessible) |
| g_object_ref (accessible); |
| return accessible; |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * Expand flag management |
| */ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->need_compute_expand) |
| { |
| gboolean h, v; |
| |
| if (priv->hexpand_set) |
| h = priv->hexpand; |
| else |
| h = FALSE; |
| |
| if (priv->vexpand_set) |
| v = priv->vexpand; |
| else |
| v = FALSE; |
| |
| /* we don't need to use compute_expand if both expands are |
| * forced by the app |
| */ |
| if (!(priv->hexpand_set && priv->vexpand_set)) |
| { |
| if (GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand != NULL) |
| { |
| gboolean ignored; |
| |
| GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->compute_expand (widget, |
| priv->hexpand_set ? &ignored : &h, |
| priv->vexpand_set ? &ignored : &v); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| priv->need_compute_expand = FALSE; |
| priv->computed_hexpand = h != FALSE; |
| priv->computed_vexpand = v != FALSE; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Mark @widget as needing to recompute its expand flags. Call |
| * this function when setting legacy expand child properties |
| * on the child of a container. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_compute_expand(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| gboolean changed_anything; |
| |
| if (widget->priv->need_compute_expand) |
| return; |
| |
| changed_anything = FALSE; |
| parent = widget; |
| while (parent != NULL) |
| { |
| if (!parent->priv->need_compute_expand) |
| { |
| parent->priv->need_compute_expand = TRUE; |
| changed_anything = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /* Note: if we had an invariant that "if a child needs to |
| * compute expand, its parents also do" then we could stop going |
| * up when we got to a parent that already needed to |
| * compute. However, in general we compute expand lazily (as |
| * soon as we see something in a subtree that is expand, we know |
| * we're expanding) and so this invariant does not hold and we |
| * have to always walk all the way up in case some ancestor |
| * is not currently need_compute_expand. |
| */ |
| |
| parent = parent->priv->parent; |
| } |
| |
| /* recomputing expand always requires |
| * a relayout as well |
| */ |
| if (changed_anything) |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_compute_expand: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * @orientation: expand direction |
| * |
| * Computes whether a container should give this widget extra space |
| * when possible. Containers should check this, rather than |
| * looking at gtk_widget_get_hexpand() or gtk_widget_get_vexpand(). |
| * |
| * This function already checks whether the widget is visible, so |
| * visibility does not need to be checked separately. Non-visible |
| * widgets are not expanded. |
| * |
| * The computed expand value uses either the expand setting explicitly |
| * set on the widget itself, or, if none has been explicitly set, |
| * the widget may expand if some of its children do. |
| * |
| * Returns: whether widget tree rooted here should be expanded |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_compute_expand (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| /* We never make a widget expand if not even showing. */ |
| if (!_gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_computed_expand (widget); |
| |
| if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) |
| return priv->computed_hexpand; |
| else |
| return priv->computed_vexpand; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_expand (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation, |
| gboolean expand) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gint expand_prop; |
| gint expand_set_prop; |
| gboolean was_both; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| expand = expand != FALSE; |
| |
| was_both = priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand; |
| |
| if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) |
| { |
| if (priv->hexpand_set && |
| priv->hexpand == expand) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->hexpand_set = TRUE; |
| priv->hexpand = expand; |
| |
| expand_prop = PROP_HEXPAND; |
| expand_set_prop = PROP_HEXPAND_SET; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (priv->vexpand_set && |
| priv->vexpand == expand) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->vexpand_set = TRUE; |
| priv->vexpand = expand; |
| |
| expand_prop = PROP_VEXPAND; |
| expand_set_prop = PROP_VEXPAND_SET; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); |
| |
| g_object_freeze_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[expand_prop]); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[expand_set_prop]); |
| if (was_both != (priv->hexpand && priv->vexpand)) |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_EXPAND]); |
| g_object_thaw_notify (G_OBJECT (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_expand_set (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation, |
| gboolean set) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| gint prop; |
| |
| set = set != FALSE; |
| |
| if (orientation == GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL) |
| { |
| if (set == priv->hexpand_set) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->hexpand_set = set; |
| prop = PROP_HEXPAND_SET; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| if (set == priv->vexpand_set) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->vexpand_set = set; |
| prop = PROP_VEXPAND_SET; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_compute_expand (widget); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[prop]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_hexpand: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * |
| * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal |
| * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE |
| * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or |
| * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to |
| * expand. |
| * |
| * Containers should use gtk_widget_compute_expand() rather than |
| * this function, to see whether a widget, or any of its children, |
| * has the expand flag set. If any child of a widget wants to |
| * expand, the parent may ask to expand also. |
| * |
| * This function only looks at the widget’s own hexpand flag, rather |
| * than computing whether the entire widget tree rooted at this widget |
| * wants to expand. |
| * |
| * Returns: whether hexpand flag is set |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->hexpand; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_hexpand: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * @expand: whether to expand |
| * |
| * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra horizontal |
| * space. When a user resizes a #GtkWindow, widgets with expand=TRUE |
| * generally receive the extra space. For example, a list or |
| * scrollable area or document in your window would often be set to |
| * expand. |
| * |
| * Call this function to set the expand flag if you would like your |
| * widget to become larger horizontally when the window has extra |
| * room. |
| * |
| * By default, widgets automatically expand if any of their children |
| * want to expand. (To see if a widget will automatically expand given |
| * its current children and state, call gtk_widget_compute_expand(). A |
| * container can decide how the expandability of children affects the |
| * expansion of the container by overriding the compute_expand virtual |
| * method on #GtkWidget.). |
| * |
| * Setting hexpand explicitly with this function will override the |
| * automatic expand behavior. |
| * |
| * This function forces the widget to expand or not to expand, |
| * regardless of children. The override occurs because |
| * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() sets the hexpand-set property (see |
| * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set()) which causes the widget’s hexpand |
| * value to be used, rather than looking at children and widget state. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean expand) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, expand); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * |
| * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_hexpand() has been used to |
| * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget. |
| * |
| * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed |
| * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not |
| * set, then the expand value depends on whether any |
| * children of the widget would like to expand. |
| * |
| * There are few reasons to use this function, but it’s here |
| * for completeness and consistency. |
| * |
| * Returns: whether hexpand has been explicitly set |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->hexpand_set; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * @set: value for hexpand-set property |
| * |
| * Sets whether the hexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_hexpand()) will |
| * be used. |
| * |
| * The hexpand-set property will be set automatically when you call |
| * gtk_widget_set_hexpand() to set hexpand, so the most likely |
| * reason to use this function would be to unset an explicit expand |
| * flag. |
| * |
| * If hexpand is set, then it overrides any computed |
| * expand value based on child widgets. If hexpand is not |
| * set, then the expand value depends on whether any |
| * children of the widget would like to expand. |
| * |
| * There are few reasons to use this function, but it’s here |
| * for completeness and consistency. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean set) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_HORIZONTAL, set); |
| } |
| |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_vexpand: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * |
| * Gets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical |
| * space. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand() for more detail. |
| * |
| * Returns: whether vexpand flag is set |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->vexpand; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_vexpand: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * @expand: whether to expand |
| * |
| * Sets whether the widget would like any available extra vertical |
| * space. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand() for more detail. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean expand) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_set_expand (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, expand); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * |
| * Gets whether gtk_widget_set_vexpand() has been used to |
| * explicitly set the expand flag on this widget. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_get_hexpand_set() for more detail. |
| * |
| * Returns: whether vexpand has been explicitly set |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_vexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->vexpand_set; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set: |
| * @widget: the widget |
| * @set: value for vexpand-set property |
| * |
| * Sets whether the vexpand flag (see gtk_widget_get_vexpand()) will |
| * be used. |
| * |
| * See gtk_widget_set_hexpand_set() for more detail. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_vexpand_set (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean set) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| gtk_widget_set_expand_set (widget, GTK_ORIENTATION_VERTICAL, set); |
| } |
| |
| /* |
| * GtkBuildable implementation |
| */ |
| static GQuark quark_builder_atk_relations = 0; |
| static GQuark quark_builder_set_name = 0; |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_add_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *type) |
| { |
| if (type != NULL) |
| { |
| GTK_BUILDER_WARN_INVALID_CHILD_TYPE (buildable, type); |
| } |
| if (GTK_IS_WIDGET (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_set_parent (GTK_WIDGET (child), GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| } |
| else if (GTK_IS_EVENT_CONTROLLER (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_add_controller (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), g_object_ref (GTK_EVENT_CONTROLLER (child))); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| g_warning ("Cannot add an object of type %s to a widget of type %s", |
| g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (child)), g_type_name (G_OBJECT_TYPE (buildable))); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_interface_init (GtkBuildableIface *iface) |
| { |
| quark_builder_atk_relations = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-atk-relations"); |
| quark_builder_set_name = g_quark_from_static_string ("gtk-builder-set-name"); |
| |
| iface->set_name = gtk_widget_buildable_set_name; |
| iface->get_name = gtk_widget_buildable_get_name; |
| iface->get_internal_child = gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child; |
| iface->parser_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished; |
| iface->custom_tag_start = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start; |
| iface->custom_tag_end = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_end; |
| iface->custom_finished = gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished; |
| iface->add_child = gtk_widget_buildable_add_child; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_set_name (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| const gchar *name) |
| { |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name, |
| g_strdup (name), g_free); |
| } |
| |
| static const gchar * |
| gtk_widget_buildable_get_name (GtkBuildable *buildable) |
| { |
| return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_set_name); |
| } |
| |
| static GObject * |
| gtk_widget_buildable_get_internal_child (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| const gchar *childname) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClass *class; |
| GSList *l; |
| GType internal_child_type = 0; |
| |
| if (strcmp (childname, "accessible") == 0) |
| return G_OBJECT (gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable))); |
| |
| /* Find a widget type which has declared an automated child as internal by |
| * the name 'childname', if any. |
| */ |
| for (class = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (buildable); |
| GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (class); |
| class = g_type_class_peek_parent (class)) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetTemplate *template = class->priv->template; |
| |
| if (!template) |
| continue; |
| |
| for (l = template->children; l && internal_child_type == 0; l = l->next) |
| { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; |
| |
| if (child_class->internal_child && strcmp (childname, child_class->name) == 0) |
| internal_child_type = G_OBJECT_CLASS_TYPE (class); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Now return the 'internal-child' from the class which declared it, note |
| * that gtk_widget_get_template_child() an API used to access objects |
| * which are in the private scope of a given class. |
| */ |
| if (internal_child_type != 0) |
| return gtk_widget_get_template_child (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), internal_child_type, childname); |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| gchar *action_name; |
| GString *description; |
| gchar *context; |
| gboolean translatable; |
| } AtkActionData; |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| gchar *target; |
| AtkRelationType type; |
| gint line; |
| gint col; |
| } AtkRelationData; |
| |
| static void |
| free_action (AtkActionData *data, gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| g_free (data->action_name); |
| g_string_free (data->description, TRUE); |
| g_free (data->context); |
| g_slice_free (AtkActionData, data); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| free_relation (AtkRelationData *data, gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| g_free (data->target); |
| g_slice_free (AtkRelationData, data); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_parser_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder) |
| { |
| GSList *atk_relations; |
| |
| atk_relations = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), |
| quark_builder_atk_relations); |
| if (atk_relations) |
| { |
| AtkObject *accessible; |
| AtkRelationSet *relation_set; |
| GSList *l; |
| GObject *target; |
| AtkObject *target_accessible; |
| |
| accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| relation_set = atk_object_ref_relation_set (accessible); |
| |
| for (l = atk_relations; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| AtkRelationData *relation = (AtkRelationData*)l->data; |
| |
| target = _gtk_builder_lookup_object (builder, relation->target, relation->line, relation->col); |
| if (!target) |
| continue; |
| target_accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (target)); |
| g_assert (target_accessible != NULL); |
| |
| atk_relation_set_add_relation_by_type (relation_set, relation->type, target_accessible); |
| } |
| g_object_unref (relation_set); |
| |
| g_slist_free_full (atk_relations, (GDestroyNotify) free_relation); |
| g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| GtkBuilder *builder; |
| GSList *actions; |
| GSList *relations; |
| AtkRole role; |
| } AccessibilitySubParserData; |
| |
| static void |
| accessibility_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const gchar *element_name, |
| const gchar **names, |
| const gchar **values, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; |
| |
| if (strcmp (element_name, "relation") == 0) |
| { |
| gchar *target = NULL; |
| gchar *type = NULL; |
| AtkRelationData *relation; |
| AtkRelationType relation_type; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "accessibility", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "target", &target, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "type", &type, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| relation_type = atk_relation_type_for_name (type); |
| if (relation_type == ATK_RELATION_NULL) |
| { |
| g_set_error (error, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_VALUE, |
| "No such relation type: '%s'", type); |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| relation = g_slice_new (AtkRelationData); |
| relation->target = g_strdup (target); |
| relation->type = relation_type; |
| |
| data->relations = g_slist_prepend (data->relations, relation); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (element_name, "action") == 0) |
| { |
| const gchar *action_name; |
| const gchar *description = NULL; |
| const gchar *msg_context = NULL; |
| gboolean translatable = FALSE; |
| AtkActionData *action; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "accessibility", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "action_name", &action_name, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "description", &description, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "comments", NULL, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "context", &msg_context, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_BOOLEAN|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "translatable", &translatable, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| action = g_slice_new (AtkActionData); |
| action->action_name = g_strdup (action_name); |
| action->description = g_string_new (description); |
| action->context = g_strdup (msg_context); |
| action->translatable = translatable; |
| |
| data->actions = g_slist_prepend (data->actions, action); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (element_name, "role") == 0) |
| { |
| const gchar *type; |
| AtkRole role; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "accessibility", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (data->role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) |
| { |
| g_set_error (error, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_VALUE, |
| "Duplicate accessibility role definition"); |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "type", &type, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| role = atk_role_for_name (type); |
| if (role == ATK_ROLE_INVALID) |
| { |
| g_set_error (error, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_VALUE, |
| "No such role type: '%s'", type); |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| data->role = role; |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (element_name, "accessibility") == 0) |
| { |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "object", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID, NULL, NULL, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (data->builder, context, |
| "GtkWidget", element_name, |
| error); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| accessibility_text (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const gchar *text, |
| gsize text_len, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| AccessibilitySubParserData *data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; |
| |
| if (strcmp (g_markup_parse_context_get_element (context), "action") == 0) |
| { |
| AtkActionData *action = data->actions->data; |
| |
| g_string_append_len (action->description, text, text_len); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static const GMarkupParser accessibility_parser = |
| { |
| accessibility_start_element, |
| NULL, |
| accessibility_text, |
| }; |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| GObject *object; |
| GtkBuilder *builder; |
| guint key; |
| guint modifiers; |
| gchar *signal; |
| } AccelGroupParserData; |
| |
| static void |
| accel_group_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const gchar *element_name, |
| const gchar **names, |
| const gchar **values, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| AccelGroupParserData *data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; |
| |
| if (strcmp (element_name, "accelerator") == 0) |
| { |
| const gchar *key_str = NULL; |
| const gchar *signal = NULL; |
| const gchar *modifiers_str = NULL; |
| guint key = 0; |
| guint modifiers = 0; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "object", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "key", &key_str, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "signal", &signal, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING|G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "modifiers", &modifiers_str, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| key = gdk_keyval_from_name (key_str); |
| if (key == 0) |
| { |
| g_set_error (error, |
| GTK_BUILDER_ERROR, GTK_BUILDER_ERROR_INVALID_VALUE, |
| "Could not parse key '%s'", key_str); |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if (modifiers_str != NULL) |
| { |
| GFlagsValue aliases[2] = { |
| { 0, "primary", "primary" }, |
| { 0, NULL, NULL } |
| }; |
| |
| aliases[0].value = _gtk_get_primary_accel_mod (); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_flags_from_string (GDK_TYPE_MODIFIER_TYPE, aliases, |
| modifiers_str, &modifiers, error)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| data->key = key; |
| data->modifiers = modifiers; |
| data->signal = g_strdup (signal); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (data->builder, context, |
| "GtkWidget", element_name, |
| error); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static const GMarkupParser accel_group_parser = |
| { |
| accel_group_start_element, |
| }; |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| GtkBuilder *builder; |
| GSList *classes; |
| } StyleParserData; |
| |
| static void |
| style_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const gchar *element_name, |
| const gchar **names, |
| const gchar **values, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| StyleParserData *data = (StyleParserData *)user_data; |
| |
| if (strcmp (element_name, "class") == 0) |
| { |
| const gchar *name; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "style", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "name", &name, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| data->classes = g_slist_prepend (data->classes, g_strdup (name)); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (element_name, "style") == 0) |
| { |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (data->builder, context, "object", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID, NULL, NULL, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (data->builder, context, error); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (data->builder, context, |
| "GtkWidget", element_name, |
| error); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static const GMarkupParser style_parser = |
| { |
| style_start_element, |
| }; |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| char *name; |
| GString *value; |
| char *context; |
| gboolean translatable; |
| } LayoutPropertyInfo; |
| |
| typedef struct |
| { |
| GObject *object; |
| GtkBuilder *builder; |
| |
| LayoutPropertyInfo *cur_property; |
| |
| /* SList<LayoutPropertyInfo> */ |
| GSList *properties; |
| } LayoutParserData; |
| |
| static void |
| layout_property_info_free (gpointer data) |
| { |
| LayoutPropertyInfo *pinfo = data; |
| |
| if (pinfo == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| g_free (pinfo->name); |
| g_free (pinfo->context); |
| g_string_free (pinfo->value, TRUE); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| layout_start_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const gchar *element_name, |
| const gchar **names, |
| const gchar **values, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| LayoutParserData *layout_data = user_data; |
| |
| if (strcmp (element_name, "property") == 0) |
| { |
| const char *name = NULL; |
| const char *ctx = NULL; |
| gboolean translatable = FALSE; |
| LayoutPropertyInfo *pinfo; |
| |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (layout_data->builder, context, "layout", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING, "name", &name, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_BOOLEAN | G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "translatable", &translatable, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_STRING | G_MARKUP_COLLECT_OPTIONAL, "context", &ctx, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (layout_data->builder, context, error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| pinfo = g_new0 (LayoutPropertyInfo, 1); |
| pinfo->name = g_strdup (name); |
| pinfo->translatable = translatable; |
| pinfo->context = g_strdup (ctx); |
| pinfo->value = g_string_new (NULL); |
| |
| layout_data->cur_property = pinfo; |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (element_name, "layout") == 0) |
| { |
| if (!_gtk_builder_check_parent (layout_data->builder, context, "object", error)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!g_markup_collect_attributes (element_name, names, values, error, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID, NULL, NULL, |
| G_MARKUP_COLLECT_INVALID)) |
| _gtk_builder_prefix_error (layout_data->builder, context, error); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| _gtk_builder_error_unhandled_tag (layout_data->builder, context, |
| "GtkWidget", element_name, |
| error); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| layout_text (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const gchar *text, |
| gsize text_len, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| LayoutParserData *layout_data = user_data; |
| |
| if (layout_data->cur_property != NULL) |
| g_string_append_len (layout_data->cur_property->value, text, text_len); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| layout_end_element (GMarkupParseContext *context, |
| const char *element_name, |
| gpointer user_data, |
| GError **error) |
| { |
| LayoutParserData *layout_data = user_data; |
| |
| if (layout_data->cur_property != NULL) |
| { |
| LayoutPropertyInfo *pinfo = g_steal_pointer (&layout_data->cur_property); |
| |
| /* Translate the string, if needed */ |
| if (pinfo->value->len != 0 && pinfo->translatable) |
| { |
| const char *translated; |
| const char *domain; |
| |
| domain = gtk_builder_get_translation_domain (layout_data->builder); |
| |
| translated = _gtk_builder_parser_translate (domain, pinfo->context, pinfo->value->str); |
| |
| g_string_assign (pinfo->value, translated); |
| } |
| |
| /* We assign all properties at the end of the `layout` section */ |
| layout_data->properties = g_slist_prepend (layout_data->properties, pinfo); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static const GMarkupParser layout_parser = |
| { |
| layout_start_element, |
| layout_end_element, |
| layout_text, |
| }; |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_start (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *tagname, |
| GMarkupParser *parser, |
| gpointer *parser_data) |
| { |
| if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0) |
| { |
| AccelGroupParserData *data; |
| |
| data = g_slice_new0 (AccelGroupParserData); |
| data->object = (GObject *)g_object_ref (buildable); |
| data->builder = builder; |
| |
| *parser = accel_group_parser; |
| *parser_data = data; |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0) |
| { |
| AccessibilitySubParserData *data; |
| |
| data = g_slice_new0 (AccessibilitySubParserData); |
| data->builder = builder; |
| |
| *parser = accessibility_parser; |
| *parser_data = data; |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0) |
| { |
| StyleParserData *data; |
| |
| data = g_slice_new0 (StyleParserData); |
| data->builder = builder; |
| |
| *parser = style_parser; |
| *parser_data = data; |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| if (strcmp (tagname, "layout") == 0) |
| { |
| LayoutParserData *data; |
| |
| data = g_slice_new0 (LayoutParserData); |
| data->builder = builder; |
| data->object = (GObject *) g_object_ref (buildable); |
| |
| *parser = layout_parser; |
| *parser_data = data; |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_custom_tag_end (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *tagname, |
| gpointer data) |
| { |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *toplevel, |
| gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| AccelGroupParserData *accel_data; |
| GSList *accel_groups; |
| GtkAccelGroup *accel_group; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (toplevel)); |
| g_return_if_fail (user_data != NULL); |
| |
| accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; |
| accel_groups = gtk_accel_groups_from_object (G_OBJECT (toplevel)); |
| if (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 0) |
| { |
| accel_group = gtk_accel_group_new (); |
| gtk_window_add_accel_group (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), accel_group); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| g_assert (g_slist_length (accel_groups) == 1); |
| accel_group = g_slist_nth_data (accel_groups, 0); |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_add_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object), |
| accel_data->signal, |
| accel_group, |
| accel_data->key, |
| accel_data->modifiers, |
| GTK_ACCEL_VISIBLE); |
| |
| g_object_unref (accel_data->object); |
| g_free (accel_data->signal); |
| g_slice_free (AccelGroupParserData, accel_data); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_finish_layout_properties (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *parent, |
| gpointer data) |
| { |
| LayoutParserData *layout_data = data; |
| GtkLayoutManager *layout_manager; |
| GtkLayoutChild *layout_child; |
| GObject *gobject; |
| GObjectClass *gobject_class; |
| GSList *layout_properties, *l; |
| |
| layout_manager = gtk_widget_get_layout_manager (parent); |
| if (layout_manager == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| layout_child = gtk_layout_manager_get_layout_child (layout_manager, widget); |
| if (layout_child == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| gobject = G_OBJECT (layout_child); |
| gobject_class = G_OBJECT_GET_CLASS (layout_child); |
| |
| layout_properties = g_slist_reverse (layout_data->properties); |
| layout_data->properties = NULL; |
| |
| for (l = layout_properties; l != NULL; l = l->next) |
| { |
| LayoutPropertyInfo *pinfo = l->data; |
| GParamSpec *pspec; |
| GValue value = G_VALUE_INIT; |
| GError *error = NULL; |
| |
| pspec = g_object_class_find_property (gobject_class, pinfo->name); |
| if (pspec == NULL) |
| { |
| g_warning ("Unable to find layout property “%s” for children " |
| "of layout managers of type “%s”", |
| pinfo->name, |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (layout_manager)); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_builder_value_from_string (layout_data->builder, |
| pspec, |
| pinfo->value->str, |
| &value, |
| &error); |
| if (error != NULL) |
| { |
| g_warning ("Failed to set property “%s.%s” to “%s”: %s", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (layout_child), |
| pinfo->name, |
| pinfo->value->str, |
| error->message); |
| g_error_free (error); |
| continue; |
| } |
| |
| g_object_set_property (gobject, pinfo->name, &value); |
| g_value_unset (&value); |
| } |
| |
| g_slist_free_full (layout_properties, layout_property_info_free); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_buildable_custom_finished (GtkBuildable *buildable, |
| GtkBuilder *builder, |
| GObject *child, |
| const gchar *tagname, |
| gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| if (strcmp (tagname, "accelerator") == 0) |
| { |
| AccelGroupParserData *accel_data; |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| |
| accel_data = (AccelGroupParserData*)user_data; |
| g_assert (accel_data->object); |
| |
| toplevel = _gtk_widget_get_toplevel (GTK_WIDGET (accel_data->object)); |
| |
| _gtk_widget_buildable_finish_accelerator (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), toplevel, user_data); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (tagname, "accessibility") == 0) |
| { |
| AccessibilitySubParserData *a11y_data; |
| |
| a11y_data = (AccessibilitySubParserData*)user_data; |
| |
| if (a11y_data->actions) |
| { |
| AtkObject *accessible; |
| AtkAction *action; |
| gint i, n_actions; |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| |
| if (ATK_IS_ACTION (accessible)) |
| { |
| action = ATK_ACTION (accessible); |
| n_actions = atk_action_get_n_actions (action); |
| |
| for (l = a11y_data->actions; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| AtkActionData *action_data = (AtkActionData*)l->data; |
| |
| for (i = 0; i < n_actions; i++) |
| if (strcmp (atk_action_get_name (action, i), |
| action_data->action_name) == 0) |
| break; |
| |
| if (i < n_actions) |
| { |
| const gchar *description; |
| |
| if (action_data->translatable && action_data->description->len) |
| description = _gtk_builder_parser_translate (gtk_builder_get_translation_domain (builder), |
| action_data->context, |
| action_data->description->str); |
| else |
| description = action_data->description->str; |
| |
| atk_action_set_description (action, i, description); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| else |
| g_warning ("accessibility action on a widget that does not implement AtkAction"); |
| |
| g_slist_free_full (a11y_data->actions, (GDestroyNotify) free_action); |
| } |
| |
| if (a11y_data->relations) |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (buildable), quark_builder_atk_relations, |
| a11y_data->relations); |
| |
| if (a11y_data->role != ATK_ROLE_INVALID) |
| { |
| AtkObject *accessible = gtk_widget_get_accessible (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| atk_object_set_role (accessible, a11y_data->role); |
| } |
| |
| g_slice_free (AccessibilitySubParserData, a11y_data); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (tagname, "style") == 0) |
| { |
| StyleParserData *style_data = (StyleParserData *)user_data; |
| GtkStyleContext *context; |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| |
| for (l = style_data->classes; l; l = l->next) |
| gtk_style_context_add_class (context, (const gchar *)l->data); |
| |
| gtk_widget_reset_style (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| |
| g_slist_free_full (style_data->classes, g_free); |
| g_slice_free (StyleParserData, style_data); |
| } |
| else if (strcmp (tagname, "layout") == 0) |
| { |
| LayoutParserData *layout_data = (LayoutParserData *) user_data; |
| GtkWidget *parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (GTK_WIDGET (buildable)); |
| |
| if (parent != NULL) |
| gtk_widget_buildable_finish_layout_properties (GTK_WIDGET (buildable), |
| parent, |
| layout_data); |
| |
| /* Free the unapplied properties, if any */ |
| g_slist_free_full (layout_data->properties, layout_property_info_free); |
| g_object_unref (layout_data->object); |
| g_slice_free (LayoutParserData, layout_data); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static GtkSizeRequestMode |
| gtk_widget_real_get_request_mode (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| /* By default widgets don't trade size at all. */ |
| return GTK_SIZE_REQUEST_CONSTANT_SIZE; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_real_measure (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOrientation orientation, |
| int for_size, |
| int *minimum, |
| int *natural, |
| int *minimum_baseline, |
| int *natural_baseline) |
| { |
| *minimum = 0; |
| *natural = 0; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_halign: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:halign property. |
| * |
| * For backwards compatibility reasons this method will never return |
| * %GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE, but instead it will convert it to |
| * %GTK_ALIGN_FILL. Baselines are not supported for horizontal |
| * alignment. |
| * |
| * Returns: the horizontal alignment of @widget |
| */ |
| GtkAlign |
| gtk_widget_get_halign (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkAlign align; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL); |
| |
| align = priv->halign; |
| if (align == GTK_ALIGN_BASELINE) |
| return GTK_ALIGN_FILL; |
| return align; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_halign: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @align: the horizontal alignment |
| * |
| * Sets the horizontal alignment of @widget. |
| * See the #GtkWidget:halign property. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_halign (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkAlign align) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->halign == align) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->halign = align; |
| gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HALIGN]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_valign: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:valign property. |
| * |
| * Returns: the vertical alignment of @widget |
| */ |
| GtkAlign |
| gtk_widget_get_valign (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_ALIGN_FILL); |
| |
| return priv->valign; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_valign: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @align: the vertical alignment |
| * |
| * Sets the vertical alignment of @widget. |
| * See the #GtkWidget:valign property. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_valign (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkAlign align) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->valign == align) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->valign = align; |
| gtk_widget_queue_allocate (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_VALIGN]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_margin_start: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-start property. |
| * |
| * Returns: The start margin of @widget |
| */ |
| gint |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_start (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->margin.left; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_margin_start: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @margin: the start margin |
| * |
| * Sets the start margin of @widget. |
| * See the #GtkWidget:margin-start property. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_start (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint margin) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); |
| |
| /* We always save margin-start as .left */ |
| |
| if (priv->margin.left == margin) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->margin.left = margin; |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_START]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_margin_end: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-end property. |
| * |
| * Returns: The end margin of @widget |
| */ |
| gint |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_end (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->margin.right; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_margin_end: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @margin: the end margin |
| * |
| * Sets the end margin of @widget. |
| * See the #GtkWidget:margin-end property. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_end (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint margin) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); |
| |
| /* We always set margin-end as .right */ |
| |
| if (priv->margin.right == margin) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->margin.right = margin; |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_END]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_margin_top: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-top property. |
| * |
| * Returns: The top margin of @widget |
| */ |
| gint |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->margin.top; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_margin_top: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @margin: the top margin |
| * |
| * Sets the top margin of @widget. |
| * See the #GtkWidget:margin-top property. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_top (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint margin) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); |
| |
| if (priv->margin.top == margin) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->margin.top = margin; |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_TOP]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the value of the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property. |
| * |
| * Returns: The bottom margin of @widget |
| */ |
| gint |
| gtk_widget_get_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->margin.bottom; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @margin: the bottom margin |
| * |
| * Sets the bottom margin of @widget. |
| * See the #GtkWidget:margin-bottom property. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_margin_bottom (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gint margin) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (margin <= G_MAXINT16); |
| |
| if (priv->margin.bottom == margin) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->margin.bottom = margin; |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_MARGIN_BOTTOM]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_clipboard: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This is a utility function to get the clipboard object for the |
| * #GdkDisplay that @widget is using. |
| * |
| * Note that this function always works, even when @widget is not |
| * realized yet. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the appropriate clipboard object. |
| **/ |
| GdkClipboard * |
| gtk_widget_get_clipboard (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return gdk_display_get_clipboard (_gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_primary_clipboard: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * This is a utility function to get the primary clipboard object |
| * for the #GdkDisplay that @widget is using. |
| * |
| * Note that this function always works, even when @widget is not |
| * realized yet. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): the appropriate clipboard object. |
| **/ |
| GdkClipboard * |
| gtk_widget_get_primary_clipboard (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return gdk_display_get_primary_clipboard (_gtk_widget_get_display (widget)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns a newly allocated list of the widgets, normally labels, for |
| * which this widget is the target of a mnemonic (see for example, |
| * gtk_label_set_mnemonic_widget()). |
| |
| * The widgets in the list are not individually referenced. If you |
| * want to iterate through the list and perform actions involving |
| * callbacks that might destroy the widgets, you |
| * must call `g_list_foreach (result, |
| * (GFunc)g_object_ref, NULL)` first, and then unref all the |
| * widgets afterwards. |
| |
| * Returns: (element-type GtkWidget) (transfer container): the list of |
| * mnemonic labels; free this list |
| * with g_list_free() when you are done with it. |
| **/ |
| GList * |
| gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GList *list = NULL; |
| GSList *l; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| for (l = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); l; l = l->next) |
| list = g_list_prepend (list, l->data); |
| |
| return list; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @label: a #GtkWidget that acts as a mnemonic label for @widget |
| * |
| * Adds a widget to the list of mnemonic labels for |
| * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). Note the |
| * list of mnemonic labels for the widget is cleared when the |
| * widget is destroyed, so the caller must make sure to update |
| * its internal state at this point as well, by using a connection |
| * to the #GtkWidget::destroy signal or a weak notifier. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *label) |
| { |
| GSList *old_list, *new_list; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label)); |
| |
| old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); |
| new_list = g_slist_prepend (old_list, label); |
| |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, |
| new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @label: a #GtkWidget that was previously set as a mnemonic label for |
| * @widget with gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label(). |
| * |
| * Removes a widget from the list of mnemonic labels for |
| * this widget. (See gtk_widget_list_mnemonic_labels()). The widget |
| * must have previously been added to the list with |
| * gtk_widget_add_mnemonic_label(). |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_remove_mnemonic_label (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *label) |
| { |
| GSList *old_list, *new_list; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (label)); |
| |
| old_list = g_object_steal_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels); |
| new_list = g_slist_remove (old_list, label); |
| |
| if (new_list) |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_mnemonic_labels, |
| new_list, (GDestroyNotify) g_slist_free); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @custom_window: (allow-none): a #GtkWindow, or %NULL |
| * |
| * Replaces the default window used for displaying |
| * tooltips with @custom_window. GTK+ will take care of showing and |
| * hiding @custom_window at the right moment, to behave likewise as |
| * the default tooltip window. If @custom_window is %NULL, the default |
| * tooltip window will be used. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWindow *custom_window) |
| { |
| gboolean has_tooltip; |
| gchar *tooltip_markup; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (custom_window == NULL || GTK_IS_WINDOW (custom_window)); |
| |
| tooltip_markup = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_markup); |
| |
| if (custom_window) |
| g_object_ref (custom_window); |
| |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window, |
| custom_window, g_object_unref); |
| |
| has_tooltip = (custom_window != NULL || tooltip_markup != NULL); |
| gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (widget, has_tooltip); |
| |
| if (has_tooltip && _gtk_widget_get_visible (widget)) |
| gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. This can be the |
| * GtkWindow created by default, or the custom tooltip window set |
| * using gtk_widget_set_tooltip_window(). |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): The #GtkWindow of the current tooltip. |
| */ |
| GtkWindow * |
| gtk_widget_get_tooltip_window (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_tooltip_window); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Triggers a tooltip query on the display where the toplevel of @widget |
| * is located. See gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query() for more |
| * information. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_trigger_tooltip_query (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gtk_tooltip_trigger_tooltip_query (widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @text: (allow-none): the contents of the tooltip for @widget |
| * |
| * Sets @text as the contents of the tooltip. This function will take |
| * care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE and of the default |
| * handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal. |
| * |
| * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-text property and gtk_tooltip_set_text(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *text) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", text, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable): the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the |
| * returned string with g_free() when done. |
| */ |
| gchar * |
| gtk_widget_get_tooltip_text (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gchar *text = NULL; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-text", &text, NULL); |
| |
| return text; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @markup: (allow-none): the contents of the tooltip for @widget, or %NULL |
| * |
| * Sets @markup as the contents of the tooltip, which is marked up with |
| * the [Pango text markup language][PangoMarkupFormat]. |
| * |
| * This function will take care of setting #GtkWidget:has-tooltip to %TRUE |
| * and of the default handler for the #GtkWidget::query-tooltip signal. |
| * |
| * See also the #GtkWidget:tooltip-markup property and |
| * gtk_tooltip_set_markup(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *markup) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| g_object_set (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", markup, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Gets the contents of the tooltip for @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable): the tooltip text, or %NULL. You should free the |
| * returned string with g_free() when done. |
| */ |
| gchar * |
| gtk_widget_get_tooltip_markup (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gchar *text = NULL; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| g_object_get (G_OBJECT (widget), "tooltip-markup", &text, NULL); |
| |
| return text; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @has_tooltip: whether or not @widget has a tooltip. |
| * |
| * Sets the has-tooltip property on @widget to @has_tooltip. See |
| * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean has_tooltip) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| has_tooltip = !!has_tooltip; |
| |
| if (priv->has_tooltip != has_tooltip) |
| { |
| priv->has_tooltip = has_tooltip; |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HAS_TOOLTIP]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the current value of the has-tooltip property. See |
| * #GtkWidget:has-tooltip for more information. |
| * |
| * Returns: current value of has-tooltip on @widget. |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_has_tooltip (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->has_tooltip; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_allocation: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @allocation: (out): a pointer to a #GtkAllocation to copy to |
| * |
| * Retrieves the widget’s allocation. |
| * |
| * Note, when implementing a #GtkContainer: a widget’s allocation will |
| * be its “adjusted” allocation, that is, the widget’s parent |
| * container typically calls gtk_widget_size_allocate() with an |
| * allocation, and that allocation is then adjusted (to handle margin |
| * and alignment for example) before assignment to the widget. |
| * gtk_widget_get_allocation() returns the adjusted allocation that |
| * was actually assigned to the widget. The adjusted allocation is |
| * guaranteed to be completely contained within the |
| * gtk_widget_size_allocate() allocation, however. So a #GtkContainer |
| * is guaranteed that its children stay inside the assigned bounds, |
| * but not that they have exactly the bounds the container assigned. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_get_allocation (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkAllocation *allocation) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| const graphene_rect_t *margin_rect; |
| float dx, dy; |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (allocation != NULL); |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| margin_rect = gtk_css_boxes_get_margin_rect (&boxes); |
| |
| if (gsk_transform_get_category (priv->transform) >= GSK_TRANSFORM_CATEGORY_2D_TRANSLATE) |
| gsk_transform_to_translate (priv->transform, &dx, &dy); |
| else |
| dx = dy = 0; |
| |
| allocation->x = dx + ceil (margin_rect->origin.x); |
| allocation->y = dy + ceil (margin_rect->origin.y); |
| allocation->width = ceil (margin_rect->size.width); |
| allocation->height = ceil (margin_rect->size.height); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_contains: |
| * @widget: the widget to query |
| * @x: X coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin |
| * @y: Y coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin |
| * |
| * Tests if the point at (@x, @y) is contained in @widget. |
| * |
| * The coordinates for (@x, @y) must be in widget coordinates, so |
| * (0, 0) is assumed to be the top left of @widget's content area. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget contains (@x, @y). |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_contains (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gdouble x, |
| gdouble y) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| return GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->contains (widget, x, y); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_pick: |
| * @widget: the widget to query |
| * @x: X coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin |
| * @y: Y coordinate to test, relative to @widget's origin |
| * @flags: Flags to influence what is picked |
| * |
| * Finds the descendant of @widget (including @widget itself) closest |
| * to the screen at the point (@x, @y). The point must be given in |
| * widget coordinates, so (0, 0) is assumed to be the top left of |
| * @widget's content area. |
| * |
| * Usually widgets will return %NULL if the given coordinate is not |
| * contained in @widget checked via gtk_widget_contains(). Otherwise |
| * they will recursively try to find a child that does not return %NULL. |
| * Widgets are however free to customize their picking algorithm. |
| * |
| * This function is used on the toplevel to determine the widget below |
| * the mouse cursor for purposes of hover hilighting and delivering events. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): The widget descendant at the given |
| * coordinate or %NULL if none. |
| **/ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_pick (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gdouble x, |
| gdouble y, |
| GtkPickFlags flags) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| if (!(flags & GTK_PICK_NON_TARGETABLE) && |
| !gtk_widget_get_can_target (widget)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| if (!(flags & GTK_PICK_INSENSITIVE) && |
| !_gtk_widget_is_sensitive (widget)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| switch (priv->overflow) |
| { |
| default: |
| case GTK_OVERFLOW_VISIBLE: |
| break; |
| |
| case GTK_OVERFLOW_HIDDEN: |
| { |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| |
| if (!gsk_rounded_rect_contains_point (gtk_css_boxes_get_padding_box (&boxes), |
| &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (x, y))) |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *picked; |
| |
| picked = gtk_window_pick_popover (GTK_WINDOW (widget), x, y, flags); |
| if (picked) |
| return picked; |
| } |
| |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_last_child (widget); |
| child; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *child_priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (child); |
| GskTransform *transform; |
| graphene_matrix_t inv; |
| GtkWidget *picked; |
| graphene_point3d_t p0, p1, res; |
| |
| if (child_priv->transform) |
| { |
| transform = gsk_transform_invert (gsk_transform_ref (child_priv->transform)); |
| if (transform == NULL) |
| continue; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| transform = NULL; |
| } |
| gsk_transform_to_matrix (transform, &inv); |
| gsk_transform_unref (transform); |
| graphene_point3d_init (&p0, x, y, 0); |
| graphene_point3d_init (&p1, x, y, 1); |
| graphene_matrix_transform_point3d (&inv, &p0, &p0); |
| graphene_matrix_transform_point3d (&inv, &p1, &p1); |
| if (fabs (p0.z - p1.z) < 1.f / 4096) |
| continue; |
| |
| graphene_point3d_interpolate (&p0, &p1, p0.z / (p0.z - p1.z), &res); |
| |
| picked = gtk_widget_pick (child, res.x, res.y, flags); |
| if (picked) |
| return picked; |
| } |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_contains (widget, x, y)) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| return widget; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_compute_transform: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @target: the target widget that the matrix will transform to |
| * @out_transform: (out caller-allocates): location to |
| * store the final transformation |
| * |
| * Computes a matrix suitable to describe a transformation from |
| * @widget's coordinate system into @target's coordinate system. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the transform could be computed, %FALSE otherwise. |
| * The transform can not be computed in certain cases, for example when |
| * @widget and @target do not share a common ancestor. In that |
| * case @out_transform gets set to the identity matrix. |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_compute_transform (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *target, |
| graphene_matrix_t *out_transform) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *ancestor, *iter; |
| graphene_matrix_t transform, inverse, tmp; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (target), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (out_transform != NULL, FALSE); |
| |
| /* optimization for common case: parent wants coordinates of a direct child */ |
| if (target == widget->priv->parent) |
| { |
| gsk_transform_to_matrix (widget->priv->transform, out_transform); |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| ancestor = gtk_widget_common_ancestor (widget, target); |
| if (ancestor == NULL) |
| { |
| graphene_matrix_init_identity (out_transform); |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| graphene_matrix_init_identity (&transform); |
| for (iter = widget; iter != ancestor; iter = iter->priv->parent) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (iter); |
| gsk_transform_to_matrix (priv->transform, &tmp); |
| |
| graphene_matrix_multiply (&transform, &tmp, &transform); |
| } |
| |
| /* optimization for common case: parent wants coordinates of a non-direct child */ |
| if (ancestor == target) |
| { |
| graphene_matrix_init_from_matrix (out_transform, &transform); |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| graphene_matrix_init_identity (&inverse); |
| for (iter = target; iter != ancestor; iter = iter->priv->parent) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (iter); |
| gsk_transform_to_matrix (priv->transform, &tmp); |
| |
| graphene_matrix_multiply (&inverse, &tmp, &inverse); |
| } |
| if (!graphene_matrix_inverse (&inverse, &inverse)) |
| { |
| graphene_matrix_init_identity (out_transform); |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| graphene_matrix_multiply (&transform, &inverse, out_transform); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_compute_bounds: |
| * @widget: the #GtkWidget to query |
| * @target: the #GtkWidget |
| * @out_bounds: (out caller-allocates): the rectangle taking the bounds |
| * |
| * Computes the bounds for @widget in the coordinate space of @target. |
| * FIXME: Explain what "bounds" are. |
| * |
| * If the operation is successful, %TRUE is returned. If @widget has no |
| * bounds or the bounds cannot be expressed in @target's coordinate space |
| * (for example if both widgets are in different windows), %FALSE is |
| * returned and @bounds is set to the zero rectangle. |
| * |
| * It is valid for @widget and @target to be the same widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if the bounds could be computed |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_compute_bounds (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *target, |
| graphene_rect_t *out_bounds) |
| { |
| graphene_matrix_t transform; |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (target), FALSE); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (out_bounds != NULL, FALSE); |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_compute_transform (widget, target, &transform)) |
| { |
| graphene_rect_init_from_rect (out_bounds, graphene_rect_zero ()); |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| graphene_matrix_transform_bounds (&transform, |
| gtk_css_boxes_get_border_rect (&boxes), |
| out_bounds); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_allocated_width: |
| * @widget: the widget to query |
| * |
| * Returns the width that has currently been allocated to @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: the width of the @widget |
| **/ |
| int |
| gtk_widget_get_allocated_width (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| |
| return gtk_css_boxes_get_margin_rect (&boxes)->size.width; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_allocated_height: |
| * @widget: the widget to query |
| * |
| * Returns the height that has currently been allocated to @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: the height of the @widget |
| **/ |
| int |
| gtk_widget_get_allocated_height (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| |
| return gtk_css_boxes_get_margin_rect (&boxes)->size.height; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline: |
| * @widget: the widget to query |
| * |
| * Returns the baseline that has currently been allocated to @widget. |
| * This function is intended to be used when implementing handlers |
| * for the #GtkWidget::snapshot function, and when allocating child |
| * widgets in #GtkWidget::size_allocate. |
| * |
| * Returns: the baseline of the @widget, or -1 if none |
| **/ |
| int |
| gtk_widget_get_allocated_baseline (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkCssStyle *style; |
| GtkBorder margin, border, padding; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| if (priv->baseline == -1) |
| return -1; |
| |
| style = gtk_css_node_get_style (priv->cssnode); |
| get_box_margin (style, &margin); |
| get_box_border (style, &border); |
| get_box_padding (style, &padding); |
| |
| return priv->baseline - margin.top - border.top - padding.top; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @surface: (transfer full): a #GdkSurface |
| * |
| * Sets a widget’s surface. This function should only be used in a |
| * widget’s #GtkWidget::realize implementation. The %surface passed is |
| * usually either new surface created with gdk_surface_new(), or the |
| * surface of its parent widget as returned by |
| * gtk_widget_get_parent_surface(). |
| * |
| * Widgets must indicate whether they will create their own #GdkSurface |
| * by calling gtk_widget_set_has_surface(). This is usually done in the |
| * widget’s init() function. |
| * |
| * Note that this function does not add any reference to @surface. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_surface (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkSurface *surface) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (surface == NULL || GDK_IS_SURFACE (surface)); |
| |
| if (priv->surface != surface) |
| { |
| priv->surface = surface; |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_SURFACE]); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| surface_expose (GdkSurface *surface, |
| cairo_region_t *region, |
| GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_render (widget, surface, region); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| surface_event (GdkSurface *surface, |
| GdkEvent *event, |
| GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gtk_main_do_event (event); |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_register_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @surface: a #GdkSurface |
| * |
| * Registers a #GdkSurface with the widget and sets it up so that |
| * the widget receives events for it. Call gtk_widget_unregister_surface() |
| * when destroying the surface. |
| * |
| * Before 3.8 you needed to call gdk_surface_set_user_data() directly to set |
| * this up. This is now deprecated and you should use gtk_widget_register_surface() |
| * instead. Old code will keep working as is, although some new features like |
| * transparency might not work perfectly. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_register_surface (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkSurface *surface) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_SURFACE (surface)); |
| |
| g_assert (gdk_surface_get_widget (surface) == NULL); |
| gdk_surface_set_widget (surface, widget); |
| |
| g_signal_connect (surface, "render", G_CALLBACK (surface_expose), widget); |
| g_signal_connect (surface, "event", G_CALLBACK (surface_event), widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_unregister_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @surface: a #GdkSurface |
| * |
| * Unregisters a #GdkSurface from the widget that was previously set up with |
| * gtk_widget_register_surface(). You need to call this when the surface is |
| * no longer used by the widget, such as when you destroy it. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_unregister_surface (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkSurface *surface) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GDK_IS_SURFACE (surface)); |
| |
| g_assert (gdk_surface_get_widget (surface) == widget); |
| gdk_surface_set_widget (surface, NULL); |
| |
| g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func (surface, surface_expose, widget); |
| g_signal_handlers_disconnect_by_func (surface, surface_event, widget); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_surface: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the widget’s surface if it is realized, %NULL otherwise |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): @widget’s surface. |
| */ |
| GdkSurface* |
| gtk_widget_get_surface (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->surface; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns %TRUE if @widget is multiple pointer aware. See |
| * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice() for more information. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is multidevice aware. |
| **/ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), FALSE); |
| |
| return priv->multidevice; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @support_multidevice: %TRUE to support input from multiple devices. |
| * |
| * Enables or disables multiple pointer awareness. If this setting is %TRUE, |
| * @widget will start receiving multiple, per device enter/leave events. Note |
| * that if custom #GdkSurfaces are created in #GtkWidget::realize, |
| * gdk_surface_set_support_multidevice() will have to be called manually on them. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_support_multidevice (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean support_multidevice) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| priv->multidevice = (support_multidevice == TRUE); |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| gdk_surface_set_support_multidevice (priv->surface, support_multidevice); |
| } |
| |
| /* There are multiple alpha related sources. First of all the user can specify alpha |
| * in gtk_widget_set_opacity, secondly we can get it from the CSS opacity. These two |
| * are multiplied together to form the total alpha. Secondly, the user can specify |
| * an opacity group for a widget, which means we must essentially handle it as having alpha. |
| */ |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_update_alpha (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkStyleContext *context; |
| gdouble opacity; |
| guint8 alpha; |
| |
| context = _gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget); |
| opacity = |
| _gtk_css_number_value_get (_gtk_style_context_peek_property (context, |
| GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_OPACITY), |
| 100); |
| opacity = CLAMP (opacity, 0.0, 1.0); |
| alpha = round (priv->user_alpha * opacity); |
| |
| if (alpha == priv->alpha) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->alpha = alpha; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_realized (widget)) |
| { |
| if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| gdk_surface_set_opacity (priv->surface, priv->alpha / 255.0); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_opacity: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @opacity: desired opacity, between 0 and 1 |
| * |
| * Request the @widget to be rendered partially transparent, |
| * with opacity 0 being fully transparent and 1 fully opaque. (Opacity values |
| * are clamped to the [0,1] range.). |
| * This works on both toplevel widget, and child widgets, although there |
| * are some limitations: |
| * |
| * For toplevel widgets this depends on the capabilities of the windowing |
| * system. On X11 this has any effect only on X displays with a compositing manager |
| * running. See gdk_display_is_composited(). On Windows it should work |
| * always, although setting a window’s opacity after the window has been |
| * shown causes it to flicker once on Windows. |
| * |
| * For child widgets it doesn’t work if any affected widget has a native window. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_opacity (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gdouble opacity) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| guint8 alpha; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| opacity = CLAMP (opacity, 0.0, 1.0); |
| |
| alpha = round (opacity * 255); |
| |
| if (alpha == priv->user_alpha) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->user_alpha = alpha; |
| |
| gtk_widget_update_alpha (widget); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_OPACITY]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_opacity: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Fetches the requested opacity for this widget. |
| * See gtk_widget_set_opacity(). |
| * |
| * Returns: the requested opacity for this widget. |
| **/ |
| gdouble |
| gtk_widget_get_opacity (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0.0); |
| |
| return priv->user_alpha / 255.0; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_overflow: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @overflow: desired overflow |
| * |
| * Sets how @widget treats content that is drawn outside the widget's content area. |
| * See the definition of #GtkOverflow for details. |
| * |
| * This setting is provided for widget implementations and should not be used by |
| * application code. |
| * |
| * The default value is %GTK_OVERFLOW_VISIBLE. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_overflow (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkOverflow overflow) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (priv->overflow == overflow) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->overflow = overflow; |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_OVERFLOW]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_overflow: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the value set via gtk_widget_set_overflow(). |
| * |
| * Returns: The widget's overflow. |
| **/ |
| GtkOverflow |
| gtk_widget_get_overflow (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), GTK_OVERFLOW_VISIBLE); |
| |
| return priv->overflow; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_has_focus (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean has_focus) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->has_focus == has_focus) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->has_focus = has_focus; |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_HAS_FOCUS]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_in_destruction: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns whether the widget is currently being destroyed. |
| * This information can sometimes be used to avoid doing |
| * unnecessary work. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget is being destroyed |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_in_destruction (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->in_destruction; |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| _gtk_widget_get_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->shadowed; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_set_shadowed (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean shadowed) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->shadowed = shadowed; |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| _gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->alloc_needed; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_set_alloc_needed (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->alloc_needed = TRUE; |
| |
| do |
| { |
| if (priv->alloc_needed_on_child) |
| break; |
| |
| priv->alloc_needed_on_child = TRUE; |
| |
| if (!priv->visible) |
| break; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_is_toplevel (widget)) |
| { |
| gtk_container_start_idle_sizer (GTK_CONTAINER (widget)); |
| break; |
| } |
| |
| widget = priv->parent; |
| if (widget == NULL) |
| break; |
| |
| priv = widget->priv; |
| } |
| while (TRUE); |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_needs_allocate (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!priv->visible || !priv->child_visible) |
| return FALSE; |
| |
| if (priv->resize_needed || priv->alloc_needed || priv->alloc_needed_on_child) |
| return TRUE; |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_ensure_allocate (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!gtk_widget_needs_allocate (widget)) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_widget_ensure_resize (widget); |
| |
| /* This code assumes that we only reach here if the previous |
| * allocation is still valid (ie no resize was queued). |
| * If that wasn't true, the parent would have taken care of |
| * things. |
| */ |
| if (priv->alloc_needed) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_allocate (widget, |
| priv->allocated_width, |
| priv->allocated_height, |
| priv->allocated_size_baseline, |
| priv->allocated_transform); |
| } |
| else if (priv->alloc_needed_on_child) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| |
| priv->alloc_needed_on_child = FALSE; |
| |
| for (child = _gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| child != NULL; |
| child = _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child)) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_ensure_allocate (child); |
| } |
| } |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_ensure_resize (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!priv->resize_needed) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->resize_needed = FALSE; |
| _gtk_size_request_cache_clear (&priv->requests); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_add_sizegroup (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gpointer group) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *groups; |
| |
| groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); |
| groups = g_slist_prepend (groups, group); |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups); |
| |
| priv->have_size_groups = TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_remove_sizegroup (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gpointer group) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GSList *groups; |
| |
| groups = g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); |
| groups = g_slist_remove (groups, group); |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups, groups); |
| |
| priv->have_size_groups = groups != NULL; |
| } |
| |
| GSList * |
| _gtk_widget_get_sizegroups (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (priv->have_size_groups) |
| return g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_size_groups); |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_add_attached_window (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWindow *window) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->attached_windows = g_list_prepend (priv->attached_windows, window); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_remove_attached_window (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWindow *window) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->attached_windows = g_list_remove (priv->attached_windows, window); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget: |
| * @path: a widget path |
| * @widget: the widget to append to the widget path |
| * |
| * Appends the data from @widget to the widget hierarchy represented |
| * by @path. This function is a shortcut for adding information from |
| * @widget to the given @path. This includes setting the name or |
| * adding the style classes from @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: the position where the data was inserted |
| */ |
| gint |
| gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (GtkWidgetPath *path, |
| GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| const GQuark *classes; |
| guint n_classes, i; |
| gint pos; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (path != NULL, 0); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| pos = gtk_widget_path_append_type (path, gtk_css_node_get_widget_type (priv->cssnode)); |
| gtk_widget_path_iter_set_object_name (path, pos, gtk_css_node_get_name (priv->cssnode)); |
| |
| if (priv->name) |
| gtk_widget_path_iter_set_name (path, pos, priv->name); |
| |
| gtk_widget_path_iter_set_state (path, pos, priv->state_flags); |
| |
| classes = gtk_css_node_list_classes (priv->cssnode, &n_classes); |
| |
| for (i = n_classes; i-- > 0;) |
| gtk_widget_path_iter_add_qclass (path, pos, classes[i]); |
| |
| return pos; |
| } |
| |
| GtkWidgetPath * |
| _gtk_widget_create_path (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); |
| |
| if (parent && GTK_IS_CONTAINER (parent)) |
| return gtk_container_get_path_for_child (GTK_CONTAINER (parent), widget); |
| else if (parent) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPath *path = _gtk_widget_create_path (parent); |
| gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (path, widget); |
| return path; |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| /* Widget is either toplevel or unparented, treat both |
| * as toplevels style wise, since there are situations |
| * where style properties might be retrieved on that |
| * situation. |
| */ |
| GtkWidget *attach_widget = NULL; |
| GtkWidgetPath *result; |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) |
| attach_widget = gtk_window_get_attached_to (GTK_WINDOW (widget)); |
| |
| if (attach_widget != NULL) |
| result = gtk_widget_path_copy (gtk_widget_get_path (attach_widget)); |
| else |
| result = gtk_widget_path_new (); |
| |
| gtk_widget_path_append_for_widget (result, widget); |
| |
| return result; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_path: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget, if the widget |
| * is not connected to a toplevel widget, a partial path will be |
| * created. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): The #GtkWidgetPath representing @widget |
| **/ |
| GtkWidgetPath * |
| gtk_widget_get_path (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPath *path; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| path = (GtkWidgetPath*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_widget_path); |
| if (!path) |
| { |
| path = _gtk_widget_create_path (widget); |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), |
| quark_widget_path, |
| path, |
| (GDestroyNotify)gtk_widget_path_free); |
| } |
| |
| return path; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_clear_path (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_object_set_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_widget_path, NULL); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_css_name: |
| * @widget_class: class to set the name on |
| * @name: name to use |
| * |
| * Sets the name to be used for CSS matching of widgets. |
| * |
| * If this function is not called for a given class, the name |
| * of the parent class is used. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_css_name (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| const char *name) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (name != NULL); |
| |
| priv = widget_class->priv; |
| |
| priv->css_name = g_intern_string (name); |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| gtk_widget_class_get_visible_by_default (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class) |
| { |
| return !(g_type_is_a (G_TYPE_FROM_CLASS (widget_class), GTK_TYPE_ROOT) || |
| GTK_IS_POPOVER_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_get_css_name: |
| * @widget_class: class to set the name on |
| * |
| * Gets the name used by this class for matching in CSS code. See |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_css_name() for details. |
| * |
| * Returns: the CSS name of the given class |
| */ |
| const char * |
| gtk_widget_class_get_css_name (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class) |
| { |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class), NULL); |
| |
| return widget_class->priv->css_name; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_style_context_invalidated (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| g_signal_emit (widget, widget_signals[STYLE_UPDATED], 0); |
| } |
| |
| GtkCssNode * |
| gtk_widget_get_css_node (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->cssnode; |
| } |
| |
| GtkStyleContext * |
| _gtk_widget_peek_style_context (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->context; |
| } |
| |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_style_context: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the style context associated to @widget. The returned object is |
| * guaranteed to be the same for the lifetime of @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): a #GtkStyleContext. This memory is owned by @widget and |
| * must not be freed. |
| **/ |
| GtkStyleContext * |
| gtk_widget_get_style_context (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (G_UNLIKELY (priv->context == NULL)) |
| { |
| GdkDisplay *display; |
| |
| priv->context = gtk_style_context_new_for_node (priv->cssnode); |
| |
| gtk_style_context_set_id (priv->context, priv->name); |
| gtk_style_context_set_state (priv->context, priv->state_flags); |
| gtk_style_context_set_scale (priv->context, gtk_widget_get_scale_factor (widget)); |
| |
| display = _gtk_widget_get_display (widget); |
| if (display) |
| gtk_style_context_set_display (priv->context, display); |
| |
| if (priv->parent) |
| gtk_style_context_set_parent (priv->context, |
| _gtk_widget_get_style_context (priv->parent)); |
| } |
| |
| return priv->context; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @intent: the use case for the modifier mask |
| * |
| * Returns the modifier mask the @widget’s windowing system backend |
| * uses for a particular purpose. |
| * |
| * See gdk_keymap_get_modifier_mask(). |
| * |
| * Returns: the modifier mask used for @intent. |
| **/ |
| GdkModifierType |
| gtk_widget_get_modifier_mask (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkModifierIntent intent) |
| { |
| GdkDisplay *display; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| display = _gtk_widget_get_display (widget); |
| |
| return gdk_keymap_get_modifier_mask (gdk_display_get_keymap (display), |
| intent); |
| } |
| |
| static GtkActionMuxer * |
| gtk_widget_get_parent_muxer (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean create) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *parent; |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) |
| return gtk_application_get_parent_muxer_for_window (GTK_WINDOW (widget)); |
| |
| if (GTK_IS_MENU (widget)) |
| parent = gtk_menu_get_attach_widget (GTK_MENU (widget)); |
| else if (GTK_IS_POPOVER (widget)) |
| parent = gtk_popover_get_relative_to (GTK_POPOVER (widget)); |
| else |
| parent = _gtk_widget_get_parent (widget); |
| |
| if (parent) |
| return _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (parent, create); |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkActionMuxer *muxer; |
| |
| muxer = (GtkActionMuxer*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_action_muxer); |
| if (muxer == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_action_muxer_set_parent (muxer, |
| gtk_widget_get_parent_muxer (widget, TRUE)); |
| } |
| |
| GtkActionMuxer * |
| _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean create) |
| { |
| GtkActionMuxer *muxer; |
| |
| muxer = (GtkActionMuxer*)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_action_muxer); |
| if (muxer) |
| return muxer; |
| |
| if (create) |
| { |
| muxer = gtk_action_muxer_new (); |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), |
| quark_action_muxer, |
| muxer, |
| g_object_unref); |
| _gtk_widget_update_parent_muxer (widget); |
| |
| return muxer; |
| } |
| else |
| return gtk_widget_get_parent_muxer (widget, FALSE); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_insert_action_group: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @name: the prefix for actions in @group |
| * @group: (allow-none): a #GActionGroup, or %NULL |
| * |
| * Inserts @group into @widget. Children of @widget that implement |
| * #GtkActionable can then be associated with actions in @group by |
| * setting their “action-name” to |
| * @prefix.`action-name`. |
| * |
| * If @group is %NULL, a previously inserted group for @name is removed |
| * from @widget. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_insert_action_group (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *name, |
| GActionGroup *group) |
| { |
| GtkActionMuxer *muxer; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (name != NULL); |
| |
| muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, TRUE); |
| |
| if (group) |
| gtk_action_muxer_insert (muxer, name, group); |
| else |
| gtk_action_muxer_remove (muxer, name); |
| } |
| |
| /**************************************************************** |
| * GtkBuilder automated templates * |
| ****************************************************************/ |
| static AutomaticChildClass * |
| template_child_class_new (const gchar *name, |
| gboolean internal_child, |
| gssize offset) |
| { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class = g_slice_new0 (AutomaticChildClass); |
| |
| child_class->name = g_strdup (name); |
| child_class->internal_child = internal_child; |
| child_class->offset = offset; |
| |
| return child_class; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| template_child_class_free (AutomaticChildClass *child_class) |
| { |
| if (child_class) |
| { |
| g_free (child_class->name); |
| g_slice_free (AutomaticChildClass, child_class); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static CallbackSymbol * |
| callback_symbol_new (const gchar *name, |
| GCallback callback) |
| { |
| CallbackSymbol *cb = g_slice_new0 (CallbackSymbol); |
| |
| cb->callback_name = g_strdup (name); |
| cb->callback_symbol = callback; |
| |
| return cb; |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| callback_symbol_free (CallbackSymbol *callback) |
| { |
| if (callback) |
| { |
| g_free (callback->callback_name); |
| g_slice_free (CallbackSymbol, callback); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| template_data_free (GtkWidgetTemplate *template_data) |
| { |
| if (template_data) |
| { |
| g_bytes_unref (template_data->data); |
| g_slist_free_full (template_data->children, (GDestroyNotify)template_child_class_free); |
| g_slist_free_full (template_data->callbacks, (GDestroyNotify)callback_symbol_free); |
| |
| if (template_data->connect_data && |
| template_data->destroy_notify) |
| template_data->destroy_notify (template_data->connect_data); |
| |
| g_slice_free (GtkWidgetTemplate, template_data); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static GHashTable * |
| get_auto_child_hash (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GType type, |
| gboolean create) |
| { |
| GHashTable *auto_children; |
| GHashTable *auto_child_hash; |
| |
| auto_children = (GHashTable *)g_object_get_qdata (G_OBJECT (widget), quark_auto_children); |
| if (auto_children == NULL) |
| { |
| if (!create) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| auto_children = g_hash_table_new_full (g_direct_hash, |
| NULL, |
| NULL, (GDestroyNotify)g_hash_table_destroy); |
| g_object_set_qdata_full (G_OBJECT (widget), |
| quark_auto_children, |
| auto_children, |
| (GDestroyNotify)g_hash_table_destroy); |
| } |
| |
| auto_child_hash = |
| g_hash_table_lookup (auto_children, GSIZE_TO_POINTER (type)); |
| |
| if (!auto_child_hash && create) |
| { |
| auto_child_hash = g_hash_table_new_full (g_str_hash, |
| g_str_equal, |
| NULL, |
| (GDestroyNotify)g_object_unref); |
| |
| g_hash_table_insert (auto_children, |
| GSIZE_TO_POINTER (type), |
| auto_child_hash); |
| } |
| |
| return auto_child_hash; |
| } |
| |
| static gboolean |
| setup_template_child (GtkWidgetTemplate *template_data, |
| GType class_type, |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class, |
| GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkBuilder *builder) |
| { |
| GHashTable *auto_child_hash; |
| GObject *object; |
| |
| object = gtk_builder_get_object (builder, child_class->name); |
| if (!object) |
| { |
| g_critical ("Unable to retrieve object '%s' from class template for type '%s' while building a '%s'", |
| child_class->name, g_type_name (class_type), G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget)); |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| /* Insert into the hash so that it can be fetched with |
| * gtk_widget_get_template_child() and also in automated |
| * implementations of GtkBuildable.get_internal_child() |
| */ |
| auto_child_hash = get_auto_child_hash (widget, class_type, TRUE); |
| g_hash_table_insert (auto_child_hash, child_class->name, g_object_ref (object)); |
| |
| if (child_class->offset != 0) |
| { |
| gpointer field_p; |
| |
| /* Assign 'object' to the specified offset in the instance (or private) data */ |
| field_p = G_STRUCT_MEMBER_P (widget, child_class->offset); |
| (* (gpointer *) field_p) = object; |
| } |
| |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_init_template: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Creates and initializes child widgets defined in templates. This |
| * function must be called in the instance initializer for any |
| * class which assigned itself a template using gtk_widget_class_set_template() |
| * |
| * It is important to call this function in the instance initializer |
| * of a #GtkWidget subclass and not in #GObject.constructed() or |
| * #GObject.constructor() for two reasons. |
| * |
| * One reason is that generally derived widgets will assume that parent |
| * class composite widgets have been created in their instance |
| * initializers. |
| * |
| * Another reason is that when calling g_object_new() on a widget with |
| * composite templates, it’s important to build the composite widgets |
| * before the construct properties are set. Properties passed to g_object_new() |
| * should take precedence over properties set in the private template XML. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_init_template (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetTemplate *template; |
| GtkBuilder *builder; |
| GError *error = NULL; |
| GObject *object; |
| GSList *l; |
| GType class_type; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| object = G_OBJECT (widget); |
| class_type = G_OBJECT_TYPE (widget); |
| |
| template = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget)->priv->template; |
| g_return_if_fail (template != NULL); |
| |
| builder = gtk_builder_new (); |
| |
| /* Add any callback symbols declared for this GType to the GtkBuilder namespace */ |
| for (l = template->callbacks; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| CallbackSymbol *callback = l->data; |
| |
| gtk_builder_add_callback_symbol (builder, callback->callback_name, callback->callback_symbol); |
| } |
| |
| /* This will build the template XML as children to the widget instance, also it |
| * will validate that the template is created for the correct GType and assert that |
| * there is no infinite recursion. |
| */ |
| if (!gtk_builder_extend_with_template (builder, widget, class_type, |
| (const gchar *)g_bytes_get_data (template->data, NULL), |
| g_bytes_get_size (template->data), |
| &error)) |
| { |
| g_critical ("Error building template class '%s' for an instance of type '%s': %s", |
| g_type_name (class_type), G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (object), error->message); |
| g_error_free (error); |
| |
| /* This should never happen, if the template XML cannot be built |
| * then it is a critical programming error. |
| */ |
| g_object_unref (builder); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| /* Build the automatic child data |
| */ |
| for (l = template->children; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class = l->data; |
| |
| /* This will setup the pointer of an automated child, and cause |
| * it to be available in any GtkBuildable.get_internal_child() |
| * invocations which may follow by reference in child classes. |
| */ |
| if (!setup_template_child (template, |
| class_type, |
| child_class, |
| widget, |
| builder)) |
| { |
| g_object_unref (builder); |
| return; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /* Connect signals. All signal data from a template receive the |
| * template instance as user data automatically. |
| * |
| * A GtkBuilderConnectFunc can be provided to gtk_widget_class_set_signal_connect_func() |
| * in order for templates to be usable by bindings. |
| */ |
| if (template->connect_func) |
| gtk_builder_connect_signals_full (builder, template->connect_func, template->connect_data); |
| else |
| gtk_builder_connect_signals (builder, object); |
| |
| g_object_unref (builder); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_template: |
| * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass |
| * @template_bytes: A #GBytes holding the #GtkBuilder XML |
| * |
| * This should be called at class initialization time to specify |
| * the GtkBuilder XML to be used to extend a widget. |
| * |
| * For convenience, gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource() is also provided. |
| * |
| * Note that any class that installs templates must call gtk_widget_init_template() |
| * in the widget’s instance initializer. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_template (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| GBytes *template_bytes) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template == NULL); |
| g_return_if_fail (template_bytes != NULL); |
| |
| widget_class->priv->template = g_slice_new0 (GtkWidgetTemplate); |
| widget_class->priv->template->data = g_bytes_ref (template_bytes); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource: |
| * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass |
| * @resource_name: The name of the resource to load the template from |
| * |
| * A convenience function to call gtk_widget_class_set_template(). |
| * |
| * Note that any class that installs templates must call gtk_widget_init_template() |
| * in the widget’s instance initializer. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_template_from_resource (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| const gchar *resource_name) |
| { |
| GError *error = NULL; |
| GBytes *bytes = NULL; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template == NULL); |
| g_return_if_fail (resource_name && resource_name[0]); |
| |
| /* This is a hack, because class initializers now access resources |
| * and GIR/gtk-doc initializes classes without initializing GTK+, |
| * we ensure that our base resources are registered here and |
| * avoid warnings which building GIRs/documentation. |
| */ |
| _gtk_ensure_resources (); |
| |
| bytes = g_resources_lookup_data (resource_name, 0, &error); |
| if (!bytes) |
| { |
| g_critical ("Unable to load resource for composite template for type '%s': %s", |
| G_OBJECT_CLASS_NAME (widget_class), error->message); |
| g_error_free (error); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| gtk_widget_class_set_template (widget_class, bytes); |
| g_bytes_unref (bytes); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback_full: |
| * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass |
| * @callback_name: The name of the callback as expected in the template XML |
| * @callback_symbol: (scope async): The callback symbol |
| * |
| * Declares a @callback_symbol to handle @callback_name from the template XML |
| * defined for @widget_type. See gtk_builder_add_callback_symbol(). |
| * |
| * Note that this must be called from a composite widget classes class |
| * initializer after calling gtk_widget_class_set_template(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_bind_template_callback_full (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| const gchar *callback_name, |
| GCallback callback_symbol) |
| { |
| CallbackSymbol *cb; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template != NULL); |
| g_return_if_fail (callback_name && callback_name[0]); |
| g_return_if_fail (callback_symbol != NULL); |
| |
| cb = callback_symbol_new (callback_name, callback_symbol); |
| widget_class->priv->template->callbacks = g_slist_prepend (widget_class->priv->template->callbacks, cb); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_connect_func: |
| * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass |
| * @connect_func: The #GtkBuilderConnectFunc to use when connecting signals in the class template |
| * @connect_data: The data to pass to @connect_func |
| * @connect_data_destroy: The #GDestroyNotify to free @connect_data, this will only be used at |
| * class finalization time, when no classes of type @widget_type are in use anymore. |
| * |
| * For use in language bindings, this will override the default #GtkBuilderConnectFunc to be |
| * used when parsing GtkBuilder XML from this class’s template data. |
| * |
| * Note that this must be called from a composite widget classes class |
| * initializer after calling gtk_widget_class_set_template(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_connect_func (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| GtkBuilderConnectFunc connect_func, |
| gpointer connect_data, |
| GDestroyNotify connect_data_destroy) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template != NULL); |
| |
| /* Defensive, destroy any previously set data */ |
| if (widget_class->priv->template->connect_data && |
| widget_class->priv->template->destroy_notify) |
| widget_class->priv->template->destroy_notify (widget_class->priv->template->connect_data); |
| |
| widget_class->priv->template->connect_func = connect_func; |
| widget_class->priv->template->connect_data = connect_data; |
| widget_class->priv->template->destroy_notify = connect_data_destroy; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_full: |
| * @widget_class: A #GtkWidgetClass |
| * @name: The “id” of the child defined in the template XML |
| * @internal_child: Whether the child should be accessible as an “internal-child” |
| * when this class is used in GtkBuilder XML |
| * @struct_offset: The structure offset into the composite widget’s instance public or private structure |
| * where the automated child pointer should be set, or 0 to not assign the pointer. |
| * |
| * Automatically assign an object declared in the class template XML to be set to a location |
| * on a freshly built instance’s private data, or alternatively accessible via gtk_widget_get_template_child(). |
| * |
| * The struct can point either into the public instance, then you should use G_STRUCT_OFFSET(WidgetType, member) |
| * for @struct_offset, or in the private struct, then you should use G_PRIVATE_OFFSET(WidgetType, member). |
| * |
| * An explicit strong reference will be held automatically for the duration of your |
| * instance’s life cycle, it will be released automatically when #GObjectClass.dispose() runs |
| * on your instance and if a @struct_offset that is != 0 is specified, then the automatic location |
| * in your instance public or private data will be set to %NULL. You can however access an automated child |
| * pointer the first time your classes #GObjectClass.dispose() runs, or alternatively in |
| * #GtkWidgetClass.destroy(). |
| * |
| * If @internal_child is specified, #GtkBuildableIface.get_internal_child() will be automatically |
| * implemented by the #GtkWidget class so there is no need to implement it manually. |
| * |
| * The wrapper macros gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child(), gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_internal(), |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_private() and gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_internal_private() |
| * might be more convenient to use. |
| * |
| * Note that this must be called from a composite widget classes class |
| * initializer after calling gtk_widget_class_set_template(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_full (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| const gchar *name, |
| gboolean internal_child, |
| gssize struct_offset) |
| { |
| AutomaticChildClass *child_class; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (widget_class->priv->template != NULL); |
| g_return_if_fail (name && name[0]); |
| |
| child_class = template_child_class_new (name, |
| internal_child, |
| struct_offset); |
| widget_class->priv->template->children = |
| g_slist_prepend (widget_class->priv->template->children, child_class); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_template_child: |
| * @widget: A #GtkWidget |
| * @widget_type: The #GType to get a template child for |
| * @name: The “id” of the child defined in the template XML |
| * |
| * Fetch an object build from the template XML for @widget_type in this @widget instance. |
| * |
| * This will only report children which were previously declared with |
| * gtk_widget_class_bind_template_child_full() or one of its |
| * variants. |
| * |
| * This function is only meant to be called for code which is private to the @widget_type which |
| * declared the child and is meant for language bindings which cannot easily make use |
| * of the GObject structure offsets. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none): The object built in the template XML with the id @name |
| */ |
| GObject * |
| gtk_widget_get_template_child (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GType widget_type, |
| const gchar *name) |
| { |
| GHashTable *auto_child_hash; |
| GObject *ret = NULL; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (g_type_name (widget_type) != NULL, NULL); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (name && name[0], NULL); |
| |
| auto_child_hash = get_auto_child_hash (widget, widget_type, FALSE); |
| |
| if (auto_child_hash) |
| ret = g_hash_table_lookup (auto_child_hash, name); |
| |
| return ret; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_list_action_prefixes: |
| * @widget: A #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Retrieves a %NULL-terminated array of strings containing the prefixes of |
| * #GActionGroup's available to @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer container): a %NULL-terminated array of strings. |
| */ |
| const gchar ** |
| gtk_widget_list_action_prefixes (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkActionMuxer *muxer; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, FALSE); |
| if (muxer) |
| return gtk_action_muxer_list_prefixes (muxer); |
| |
| return g_new0 (const gchar *, 1); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_action_group: |
| * @widget: A #GtkWidget |
| * @prefix: The “prefix” of the action group. |
| * |
| * Retrieves the #GActionGroup that was registered using @prefix. The resulting |
| * #GActionGroup may have been registered to @widget or any #GtkWidget in its |
| * ancestry. |
| * |
| * If no action group was found matching @prefix, then %NULL is returned. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): A #GActionGroup or %NULL. |
| */ |
| GActionGroup * |
| gtk_widget_get_action_group (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const gchar *prefix) |
| { |
| GtkActionMuxer *muxer; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| g_return_val_if_fail (prefix, NULL); |
| |
| muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, FALSE); |
| if (muxer) |
| return gtk_action_muxer_lookup (muxer, prefix); |
| |
| return NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_activate_action: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @name: a prefixed action name |
| * @parameter: parameters that required by the action |
| * |
| * Looks up the action in the action groups associated |
| * with @widget and its ancestors, and activates it. |
| * |
| * The action name is expected to be prefixed with the |
| * prefix that was used when adding the action group |
| * with gtk_widget_insert_action_group(). |
| * |
| * The @parameter must match the actions expected parameter |
| * type, as returned by g_action_get_parameter_type(). |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_activate_action (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const char *name, |
| GVariant *parameter) |
| { |
| GtkActionMuxer *muxer; |
| |
| muxer = _gtk_widget_get_action_muxer (widget, FALSE); |
| if (muxer) |
| g_action_group_activate_action (G_ACTION_GROUP (muxer), |
| name, |
| parameter); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_activate_default: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Activate the default.activate action from @widget. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_activate_default (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| gtk_widget_activate_action (widget, "default.activate", NULL); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_cancel_event_sequence (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkGesture *gesture, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence, |
| GtkEventSequenceState state) |
| { |
| gboolean handled = FALSE; |
| GtkWidget *event_widget; |
| gboolean cancel = TRUE; |
| const GdkEvent *event; |
| |
| handled = _gtk_widget_set_sequence_state_internal (widget, sequence, |
| state, gesture); |
| |
| if (!handled || state != GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_CLAIMED) |
| return; |
| |
| event = _gtk_widget_get_last_event (widget, sequence); |
| |
| if (!event) |
| return; |
| |
| event_widget = gtk_get_event_target ((GdkEvent *) event); |
| |
| while (event_widget) |
| { |
| if (event_widget == widget) |
| cancel = FALSE; |
| else if (cancel) |
| _gtk_widget_cancel_sequence (event_widget, sequence); |
| else |
| _gtk_widget_set_sequence_state_internal (event_widget, sequence, |
| GTK_EVENT_SEQUENCE_DENIED, |
| NULL); |
| |
| event_widget = _gtk_widget_get_parent (event_widget); |
| } |
| |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_add_controller: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @controller: (transfer full): a #GtkEventController that hasn't been |
| * added to a widget yet |
| * |
| * Adds @controller to @widget so that it will receive events. You will |
| * usually want to call this function right after creating any kind of |
| * #GtkEventController. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_add_controller (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkEventController *controller) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_EVENT_CONTROLLER (controller)); |
| g_return_if_fail (gtk_event_controller_get_widget (controller) == NULL); |
| |
| GTK_EVENT_CONTROLLER_GET_CLASS (controller)->set_widget (controller, widget); |
| |
| priv->event_controllers = g_list_prepend (priv->event_controllers, controller); |
| |
| if (priv->controller_observer) |
| gtk_list_list_model_item_added_at (priv->controller_observer, 0); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_remove_controller: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @controller: (transfer none): a #GtkEventController |
| * |
| * Removes @controller from @widget, so that it doesn't process |
| * events anymore. It should not be used again. |
| * |
| * Widgets will remove all event controllers automatically when they |
| * are destroyed, there is normally no need to call this function. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_remove_controller (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkEventController *controller) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *before, *list; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_EVENT_CONTROLLER (controller)); |
| g_return_if_fail (gtk_event_controller_get_widget (controller) == widget); |
| |
| GTK_EVENT_CONTROLLER_GET_CLASS (controller)->unset_widget (controller); |
| |
| list = g_list_find (priv->event_controllers, controller); |
| before = list->prev; |
| priv->event_controllers = g_list_delete_link (priv->event_controllers, list); |
| g_object_unref (controller); |
| |
| if (priv->controller_observer) |
| gtk_list_list_model_item_removed (priv->controller_observer, before); |
| } |
| |
| gboolean |
| _gtk_widget_consumes_motion (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkEventSequence *sequence) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| while (widget != NULL && !GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) |
| { |
| GList *l; |
| |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (controller == NULL || |
| !GTK_IS_GESTURE (controller)) |
| continue; |
| |
| if ((!GTK_IS_GESTURE_SINGLE (controller) || |
| GTK_IS_GESTURE_DRAG (controller) || |
| GTK_IS_GESTURE_SWIPE (controller)) && |
| gtk_gesture_handles_sequence (GTK_GESTURE (controller), sequence)) |
| return TRUE; |
| } |
| |
| widget = priv->parent; |
| priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| } |
| |
| return FALSE; |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_reset_controllers (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GList *l; |
| |
| /* Reset all controllers */ |
| for (l = priv->event_controllers; l; l = l->next) |
| { |
| GtkEventController *controller = l->data; |
| |
| if (controller == NULL) |
| continue; |
| |
| gtk_event_controller_reset (controller); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static inline void |
| gtk_widget_maybe_add_debug_render_nodes (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkSnapshot *snapshot) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GdkDisplay *display = _gtk_widget_get_display (widget); |
| |
| if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, BASELINES)) |
| { |
| if (priv->baseline != -1) |
| { |
| GdkRGBA red = {1, 0, 0, 1}; |
| graphene_rect_t bounds; |
| |
| /* Baselines are relative to the widget's origin, |
| * and we are offset to the widget's allocation here */ |
| graphene_rect_init (&bounds, |
| 0, priv->baseline, |
| priv->width, 1); |
| gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, |
| &red, |
| &bounds); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG |
| if (GTK_DISPLAY_DEBUG_CHECK (display, RESIZE) && priv->highlight_resize) |
| { |
| GdkRGBA blue = {0, 0, 1, 0.2}; |
| graphene_rect_t bounds; |
| |
| graphene_rect_init (&bounds, |
| 0, 0, |
| priv->width, priv->height); |
| |
| gtk_snapshot_append_color (snapshot, |
| &blue, |
| &bounds); |
| priv->highlight_resize = FALSE; |
| gtk_widget_queue_draw (widget); |
| } |
| #endif |
| } |
| |
| static GskRenderNode * |
| gtk_widget_create_render_node (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkSnapshot *parent_snapshot) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClass *klass = GTK_WIDGET_GET_CLASS (widget); |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkCssBoxes boxes; |
| GtkCssValue *filter_value; |
| double opacity; |
| GtkSnapshot *snapshot; |
| |
| opacity = priv->alpha / 255.0; |
| if (opacity <= 0.0) |
| return NULL; |
| |
| gtk_css_boxes_init (&boxes, widget); |
| snapshot = gtk_snapshot_new_with_parent (parent_snapshot); |
| |
| gtk_snapshot_push_debug (snapshot, |
| "RenderNode for %s %p", |
| G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| |
| filter_value = _gtk_style_context_peek_property (_gtk_widget_get_style_context (widget), GTK_CSS_PROPERTY_FILTER); |
| gtk_css_filter_value_push_snapshot (filter_value, snapshot); |
| |
| if (opacity < 1.0) |
| gtk_snapshot_push_opacity (snapshot, opacity); |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_WINDOW (widget)) |
| { |
| gtk_css_style_snapshot_background (&boxes, snapshot); |
| gtk_css_style_snapshot_border (&boxes, snapshot); |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->overflow == GTK_OVERFLOW_HIDDEN) |
| gtk_snapshot_push_rounded_clip (snapshot, gtk_css_boxes_get_padding_box (&boxes)); |
| |
| klass->snapshot (widget, snapshot); |
| |
| if (priv->overflow == GTK_OVERFLOW_HIDDEN) |
| gtk_snapshot_pop (snapshot); |
| |
| gtk_css_style_snapshot_outline (&boxes, snapshot); |
| |
| if (opacity < 1.0) |
| gtk_snapshot_pop (snapshot); |
| |
| gtk_css_filter_value_pop_snapshot (filter_value, snapshot); |
| |
| #ifdef G_ENABLE_DEBUG |
| gtk_widget_maybe_add_debug_render_nodes (widget, snapshot); |
| #endif |
| |
| gtk_snapshot_pop (snapshot); |
| |
| return gtk_snapshot_free_to_node (snapshot); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_snapshot (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkSnapshot *snapshot) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| if (!_gtk_widget_is_drawable (widget)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (_gtk_widget_get_alloc_needed (widget)) |
| { |
| g_warning ("Trying to snapshot %s %p without a current allocation", G_OBJECT_TYPE_NAME (widget), widget); |
| return; |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->draw_needed) |
| { |
| GskRenderNode *render_node; |
| |
| gtk_widget_push_paintables (widget); |
| |
| render_node = gtk_widget_create_render_node (widget, snapshot); |
| /* This can happen when nested drawing happens and a widget contains itself |
| * or when we replace a clipped area */ |
| g_clear_pointer (&priv->render_node, gsk_render_node_unref); |
| priv->render_node = render_node; |
| |
| priv->draw_needed = FALSE; |
| |
| gtk_widget_pop_paintables (widget); |
| gtk_widget_update_paintables (widget); |
| } |
| |
| if (priv->render_node) |
| gtk_snapshot_append_node (snapshot, priv->render_node); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_render (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkSurface *surface, |
| const cairo_region_t *region) |
| { |
| GtkSnapshot *snapshot; |
| GskRenderer *renderer; |
| GskRenderNode *root; |
| int x, y; |
| |
| if (!GTK_IS_ROOT (widget)) |
| return; |
| |
| /* We only render double buffered on native windows */ |
| if (!gdk_surface_has_native (surface)) |
| return; |
| |
| renderer = gtk_root_get_renderer (GTK_ROOT (widget)); |
| if (renderer == NULL) |
| return; |
| |
| snapshot = gtk_snapshot_new (); |
| gtk_root_get_surface_transform (GTK_ROOT (widget), &x, &y); |
| gtk_snapshot_translate (snapshot, &GRAPHENE_POINT_INIT (x, y)); |
| gtk_widget_snapshot (widget, snapshot); |
| root = gtk_snapshot_free_to_node (snapshot); |
| |
| if (root != NULL) |
| { |
| root = gtk_inspector_prepare_render (widget, |
| renderer, |
| surface, |
| region, |
| root); |
| |
| gsk_renderer_render (renderer, root, region); |
| |
| gsk_render_node_unref (root); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_child_observer_destroyed (gpointer widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->children_observer = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_observe_children: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns a #GListModel to track the children of @widget. |
| * |
| * Calling this function will enable extra internal bookkeeping to track |
| * children and emit signals on the returned listmodel. It may slow down |
| * operations a lot. |
| * |
| * Applications should try hard to avoid calling this function because of |
| * the slowdowns. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer full): a #GListModel tracking @widget's children |
| **/ |
| GListModel * |
| gtk_widget_observe_children (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (priv->children_observer) |
| return g_object_ref (G_LIST_MODEL (priv->children_observer)); |
| |
| priv->children_observer = gtk_list_list_model_new (GTK_TYPE_WIDGET, |
| (gpointer) gtk_widget_get_first_child, |
| (gpointer) gtk_widget_get_next_sibling, |
| (gpointer) gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling, |
| (gpointer) gtk_widget_get_last_child, |
| (gpointer) g_object_ref, |
| widget, |
| gtk_widget_child_observer_destroyed); |
| |
| return G_LIST_MODEL (priv->children_observer); |
| } |
| |
| static void |
| gtk_widget_controller_observer_destroyed (gpointer widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| priv->controller_observer = NULL; |
| } |
| |
| static gpointer |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_first (gpointer widget) |
| { |
| return GTK_WIDGET (widget)->priv->event_controllers; |
| } |
| |
| static gpointer |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_next (gpointer item, |
| gpointer widget) |
| { |
| return g_list_next (item); |
| } |
| |
| static gpointer |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_prev (gpointer item, |
| gpointer widget) |
| { |
| return g_list_previous (item); |
| } |
| |
| static gpointer |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_item (gpointer item, |
| gpointer widget) |
| { |
| return g_object_ref (((GList *) item)->data); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_observe_controllers: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns a #GListModel to track the #GtkEventControllers of @widget. |
| * |
| * Calling this function will enable extra internal bookkeeping to track |
| * controllers and emit signals on the returned listmodel. It may slow down |
| * operations a lot. |
| * |
| * Applications should try hard to avoid calling this function because of |
| * the slowdowns. |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer full): a #GListModel tracking @widget's controllers |
| **/ |
| GListModel * |
| gtk_widget_observe_controllers (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| if (priv->controller_observer) |
| return g_object_ref (G_LIST_MODEL (priv->controller_observer)); |
| |
| priv->controller_observer = gtk_list_list_model_new (GTK_TYPE_EVENT_CONTROLLER, |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_first, |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_next, |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_prev, |
| NULL, |
| gtk_widget_controller_list_get_item, |
| widget, |
| gtk_widget_controller_observer_destroyed); |
| |
| return G_LIST_MODEL (priv->controller_observer); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_first_child: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's first child |
| */ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_first_child (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->first_child; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_last_child: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's last child |
| */ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_last_child (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->last_child; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_next_sibling: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's next sibling |
| */ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->next_sibling; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): The widget's previous sibling |
| */ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->prev_sibling; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_insert_after: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @parent: the parent #GtkWidget to insert @widget into |
| * @previous_sibling: (nullable): the new previous sibling of @widget or %NULL |
| * |
| * Inserts @widget into the child widget list of @parent. |
| * It will be placed after @previous_sibling, or at the beginning if @previous_sibling is %NULL. |
| * |
| * After calling this function, gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling(widget) will return @previous_sibling. |
| * |
| * If @parent is already set as the parent widget of @widget, this function can also be used |
| * to reorder @widget in the child widget list of @parent. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_insert_after (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *parent, |
| GtkWidget *previous_sibling) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); |
| g_return_if_fail (previous_sibling == NULL || GTK_IS_WIDGET (previous_sibling)); |
| g_return_if_fail (previous_sibling == NULL || _gtk_widget_get_parent (previous_sibling) == parent); |
| |
| if (widget == previous_sibling || |
| (previous_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (widget) == previous_sibling)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!previous_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_first_child (parent) == widget) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_widget_reposition_after (widget, |
| parent, |
| previous_sibling); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_insert_before: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @parent: the parent #GtkWidget to insert @widget into |
| * @next_sibling: (nullable): the new next sibling of @widget or %NULL |
| * |
| * Inserts @widget into the child widget list of @parent. |
| * It will be placed before @next_sibling, or at the end if @next_sibling is %NULL. |
| * |
| * After calling this function, gtk_widget_get_next_sibling(widget) will return @next_sibling. |
| * |
| * If @parent is already set as the parent widget of @widget, this function can also be used |
| * to reorder @widget in the child widget list of @parent. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_insert_before (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *parent, |
| GtkWidget *next_sibling) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (parent)); |
| g_return_if_fail (next_sibling == NULL || GTK_IS_WIDGET (next_sibling)); |
| g_return_if_fail (next_sibling == NULL || _gtk_widget_get_parent (next_sibling) == parent); |
| |
| if (widget == next_sibling || |
| (next_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (widget) == next_sibling)) |
| return; |
| |
| if (!next_sibling && _gtk_widget_get_last_child (parent) == widget) |
| return; |
| |
| gtk_widget_reposition_after (widget, parent, |
| next_sibling ? _gtk_widget_get_prev_sibling (next_sibling) : |
| _gtk_widget_get_last_child (parent)); |
| } |
| |
| void |
| gtk_widget_forall (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkCallback callback, |
| gpointer user_data) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *child; |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| child = gtk_widget_get_first_child (widget); |
| while (child) |
| { |
| GtkWidget *next = gtk_widget_get_next_sibling (child); |
| |
| callback(child, user_data); |
| |
| child = next; |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_snapshot_child: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @child: a child of @widget |
| * @snapshot: #GtkSnapshot as passed to the widget. In particular, no |
| * calls to gtk_snapshot_translate() or other transform calls should |
| * have been made. |
| * |
| * When a widget receives a call to the snapshot function, it must send |
| * synthetic #GtkWidget::snapshot calls to all children. This function |
| * provides a convenient way of doing this. A widget, when it receives |
| * a call to its #GtkWidget::snapshot function, calls |
| * gtk_widget_snapshot_child() once for each child, passing in |
| * the @snapshot the widget received. |
| * |
| * gtk_widget_snapshot_child() takes care of translating the origin of |
| * @snapshot, and deciding whether the child needs to be snapshot. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_snapshot_child (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *child, |
| GtkSnapshot *snapshot) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (child); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (_gtk_widget_get_parent (child) == widget); |
| g_return_if_fail (snapshot != NULL); |
| |
| gtk_snapshot_save (snapshot); |
| gtk_snapshot_transform (snapshot, priv->transform); |
| |
| gtk_widget_snapshot (child, snapshot); |
| |
| gtk_snapshot_restore (snapshot); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_focus_child: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @child: (nullable): a direct child widget of @widget or %NULL |
| * to unset the focus child of @widget |
| * |
| * Set @child as the current focus child of @widget. The previous |
| * focus child will be unset. |
| * |
| * This function is only suitable for widget implementations. |
| * If you want a certain widget to get the input focus, call |
| * gtk_widget_grab_focus() on it. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_focus_child (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkWidget *child) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (child != NULL) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (child)); |
| g_return_if_fail (gtk_widget_get_parent (child) == widget); |
| } |
| |
| g_set_object (&priv->focus_child, child); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_focus_child: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the current focus child of @widget. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): The current focus child of @widget, |
| * or %NULL in case the focus child is unset. |
| */ |
| GtkWidget * |
| gtk_widget_get_focus_child (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->focus_child; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_cursor: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @cursor: (allow-none): the new cursor or %NULL to use the default |
| * cursor |
| * |
| * Sets the cursor to be shown when pointer devices point towards @widget. |
| * |
| * If the @cursor is NULL, @widget will use the cursor inherited from the |
| * parent widget. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_cursor (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GdkCursor *cursor) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| GtkWidget *toplevel; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (cursor == NULL || GDK_IS_CURSOR (cursor)); |
| |
| if (!g_set_object (&priv->cursor, cursor)) |
| return; |
| |
| toplevel = gtk_widget_get_toplevel (widget); |
| if (GTK_IS_WINDOW (toplevel)) |
| gtk_window_maybe_update_cursor (GTK_WINDOW (toplevel), widget, NULL); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_CURSOR]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_cursor_from_name: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @name: (nullable): The name of the cursor or %NULL to use the default |
| * cursor |
| * |
| * Sets a named cursor to be shown when pointer devices point towards @widget. |
| * |
| * This is a utility function that creates a cursor via |
| * gdk_cursor_new_from_name() and then sets it on @widget with |
| * gtk_widget_set_cursor(). See those 2 functions for details. |
| * |
| * On top of that, this function allows @name to be %NULL, which will |
| * do the same as calling gtk_widget_set_cursor() with a %NULL cursor. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_cursor_from_name (GtkWidget *widget, |
| const char *name) |
| { |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| |
| if (name) |
| { |
| GdkCursor *cursor; |
| |
| cursor = gdk_cursor_new_from_name (name, NULL); |
| gtk_widget_set_cursor (widget, cursor); |
| g_object_unref (cursor); |
| } |
| else |
| { |
| gtk_widget_set_cursor (widget, NULL); |
| } |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_cursor: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Queries the cursor set via gtk_widget_set_cursor(). See that function for |
| * details. |
| * |
| * Returns: (nullable) (transfer none): the cursor currently in use or %NULL |
| * to use the default. |
| **/ |
| GdkCursor * |
| gtk_widget_get_cursor (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->cursor; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_can_target: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @can_target: whether this widget should be able to receive pointer events |
| * |
| * Sets whether @widget can be the target of pointer events. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_can_target (GtkWidget *widget, |
| gboolean can_target) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| can_target = !!can_target; |
| |
| if (priv->can_target == can_target) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->can_target = can_target; |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_CAN_TARGET]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_can_target: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Queries whether @widget can be the target of pointer events. |
| * |
| * Returns: %TRUE if @widget can receive pointer events |
| */ |
| gboolean |
| gtk_widget_get_can_target (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| return priv->can_target; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_width: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the content width of the widget, as passed to its size-allocate implementation. |
| * This is the size you should be using in GtkWidgetClass.snapshot(). For pointer |
| * events, see gtk_widget_contains(). |
| * |
| * Returns: The width of @widget |
| */ |
| int |
| gtk_widget_get_width (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->width; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_height: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Returns the content height of the widget, as passed to its size-allocate implementation. |
| * This is the size you should be using in GtkWidgetClass.snapshot(). For pointer |
| * events, see gtk_widget_contains(). |
| * |
| * Returns: The height of @widget |
| */ |
| int |
| gtk_widget_get_height (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), 0); |
| |
| return priv->height; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_set_layout_manager_type: |
| * @widget_class: class to set the layout manager type for |
| * @type: The object type that implements the #GtkLayoutManager for @widget_class |
| * |
| * Sets the type to be used for creating layout managers for widgets of |
| * @widget_class. The given @type must be a subtype of #GtkLayoutManager. |
| * |
| * This function should only be called from class init functions of widgets. |
| **/ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_class_set_layout_manager_type (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class, |
| GType type) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class)); |
| g_return_if_fail (g_type_is_a (type, GTK_TYPE_LAYOUT_MANAGER)); |
| |
| priv = widget_class->priv; |
| |
| priv->layout_manager_type = type; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_class_get_layout_manager_type: |
| * @widget_class: a #GtkWidgetClass |
| * |
| * Retrieves the type of the #GtkLayoutManager used by the #GtkWidget class. |
| * |
| * See also: gtk_widget_class_set_layout_manager_type() |
| * |
| * Returns: a #GtkLayoutManager subclass, or %G_TYPE_INVALID |
| */ |
| GType |
| gtk_widget_class_get_layout_manager_type (GtkWidgetClass *widget_class) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetClassPrivate *priv; |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET_CLASS (widget_class), G_TYPE_INVALID); |
| |
| priv = widget_class->priv; |
| |
| return priv->layout_manager_type; |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_set_layout_manager: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * @layout_manager: (nullable) (transfer full): a #GtkLayoutManager |
| * |
| * Sets the layout manager delegate instance that provides an implementation |
| * for measuring and allocating the children of @widget. |
| */ |
| void |
| gtk_widget_set_layout_manager (GtkWidget *widget, |
| GtkLayoutManager *layout_manager) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget)); |
| g_return_if_fail (layout_manager == NULL || GTK_IS_LAYOUT_MANAGER (layout_manager)); |
| g_return_if_fail (layout_manager == NULL || gtk_layout_manager_get_widget (layout_manager) == NULL); |
| |
| if (priv->layout_manager == layout_manager) |
| return; |
| |
| priv->layout_manager = layout_manager; |
| if (priv->layout_manager != NULL) |
| gtk_layout_manager_set_widget (priv->layout_manager, widget); |
| |
| gtk_widget_queue_resize (widget); |
| |
| g_object_notify_by_pspec (G_OBJECT (widget), widget_props[PROP_LAYOUT_MANAGER]); |
| } |
| |
| /** |
| * gtk_widget_get_layout_manager: |
| * @widget: a #GtkWidget |
| * |
| * Retrieves the layout manager set using gtk_widget_set_layout_manager(). |
| * |
| * Returns: (transfer none) (nullable): a #GtkLayoutManager |
| */ |
| GtkLayoutManager * |
| gtk_widget_get_layout_manager (GtkWidget *widget) |
| { |
| GtkWidgetPrivate *priv = gtk_widget_get_instance_private (widget); |
| |
| g_return_val_if_fail (GTK_IS_WIDGET (widget), NULL); |
| |
| return priv->layout_manager; |
| } |